US20080139594A1 - Imidazo-Pyridine Derivatives For Use In The Treatment of Herpes Viral Infection - Google Patents
Imidazo-Pyridine Derivatives For Use In The Treatment of Herpes Viral Infection Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20080139594A1 US20080139594A1 US11/381,422 US38142206A US2008139594A1 US 20080139594 A1 US20080139594 A1 US 20080139594A1 US 38142206 A US38142206 A US 38142206A US 2008139594 A1 US2008139594 A1 US 2008139594A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- formula
- het
- group
- cycloalkyl
- alkyl
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Abandoned
Links
- 238000011282 treatment Methods 0.000 title claims description 43
- 206010019972 Herpes viral infections Diseases 0.000 title claims description 23
- 125000004857 imidazopyridinyl group Chemical class N1C(=NC2=C1C=CC=N2)* 0.000 title 1
- 150000001875 compounds Chemical class 0.000 claims abstract description 337
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 claims abstract description 71
- 230000008569 process Effects 0.000 claims abstract description 25
- 239000008194 pharmaceutical composition Substances 0.000 claims abstract description 18
- 125000000217 alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 114
- 125000000753 cycloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 90
- 125000005843 halogen group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 68
- 125000003118 aryl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 61
- 125000003342 alkenyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 50
- 125000001072 heteroaryl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 47
- 229910052739 hydrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 claims description 43
- 125000004429 atom Chemical group 0.000 claims description 42
- 125000000392 cycloalkenyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 39
- 125000004093 cyano group Chemical group *C#N 0.000 claims description 36
- 150000003839 salts Chemical class 0.000 claims description 36
- 125000006704 (C5-C6) cycloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 33
- 125000000449 nitro group Chemical group [O-][N+](*)=O 0.000 claims description 33
- 241001465754 Metazoa Species 0.000 claims description 31
- 125000000304 alkynyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 28
- 125000000852 azido group Chemical group *N=[N+]=[N-] 0.000 claims description 27
- 208000037265 diseases, disorders, signs and symptoms Diseases 0.000 claims description 27
- 201000010099 disease Diseases 0.000 claims description 26
- 125000004070 6 membered heterocyclic group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 22
- 125000002373 5 membered heterocyclic group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 21
- 238000004519 manufacturing process Methods 0.000 claims description 16
- 125000005842 heteroatom Chemical group 0.000 claims description 15
- 241000700588 Human alphaherpesvirus 1 Species 0.000 claims description 12
- 241000701074 Human alphaherpesvirus 2 Species 0.000 claims description 11
- HDOVUKNUBWVHOX-QMMMGPOBSA-N Valacyclovir Chemical compound N1C(N)=NC(=O)C2=C1N(COCCOC(=O)[C@@H](N)C(C)C)C=N2 HDOVUKNUBWVHOX-QMMMGPOBSA-N 0.000 claims description 8
- MKUXAQIIEYXACX-UHFFFAOYSA-N aciclovir Chemical compound N1C(N)=NC(=O)C2=C1N(COCCO)C=N2 MKUXAQIIEYXACX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 8
- 229960004150 aciclovir Drugs 0.000 claims description 7
- 239000003443 antiviral agent Substances 0.000 claims description 7
- 239000003085 diluting agent Substances 0.000 claims description 7
- 229940093257 valacyclovir Drugs 0.000 claims description 7
- 239000003937 drug carrier Substances 0.000 claims description 5
- 150000004820 halides Chemical class 0.000 claims description 5
- 239000008177 pharmaceutical agent Substances 0.000 abstract 1
- ZMXDDKWLCZADIW-UHFFFAOYSA-N N,N-Dimethylformamide Chemical compound CN(C)C=O ZMXDDKWLCZADIW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 60
- 125000000623 heterocyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 45
- HEDRZPFGACZZDS-MICDWDOJSA-N Trichloro(2H)methane Chemical compound [2H]C(Cl)(Cl)Cl HEDRZPFGACZZDS-MICDWDOJSA-N 0.000 description 36
- 239000000203 mixture Substances 0.000 description 34
- 239000002585 base Substances 0.000 description 30
- 238000011321 prophylaxis Methods 0.000 description 30
- 0 CC.CC.CC.[2*]N(C1=CC=CC=C1)C1=[Y]C(C2=C(C3=CC=CC=C3)N=C3C=CC=CN32)=C([4*])C([3*])=N1 Chemical compound CC.CC.CC.[2*]N(C1=CC=CC=C1)C1=[Y]C(C2=C(C3=CC=CC=C3)N=C3C=CC=CN32)=C([4*])C([3*])=N1 0.000 description 29
- 239000002904 solvent Substances 0.000 description 28
- LFQSCWFLJHTTHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Ethanol Chemical compound CCO LFQSCWFLJHTTHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 27
- 238000006243 chemical reaction Methods 0.000 description 26
- 239000012453 solvate Substances 0.000 description 25
- YMWUJEATGCHHMB-UHFFFAOYSA-N Dichloromethane Chemical compound ClCCl YMWUJEATGCHHMB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 24
- -1 monosubstituted phenyl Chemical group 0.000 description 23
- 241000282414 Homo sapiens Species 0.000 description 22
- JUJWROOIHBZHMG-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pyridine Chemical group C1=CC=NC=C1 JUJWROOIHBZHMG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 22
- 238000009472 formulation Methods 0.000 description 22
- 238000002360 preparation method Methods 0.000 description 22
- 239000007787 solid Substances 0.000 description 22
- 125000003349 3-pyridyl group Chemical group N1=C([H])C([*])=C([H])C([H])=C1[H] 0.000 description 21
- XEKOWRVHYACXOJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Ethyl acetate Chemical compound CCOC(C)=O XEKOWRVHYACXOJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 21
- ZMANZCXQSJIPKH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Triethylamine Chemical compound CCN(CC)CC ZMANZCXQSJIPKH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 21
- 238000005160 1H NMR spectroscopy Methods 0.000 description 20
- BWHMMNNQKKPAPP-UHFFFAOYSA-L potassium carbonate Chemical compound [K+].[K+].[O-]C([O-])=O BWHMMNNQKKPAPP-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 20
- OKKJLVBELUTLKV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Methanol Chemical compound OC OKKJLVBELUTLKV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 18
- 239000000243 solution Substances 0.000 description 18
- 239000000543 intermediate Substances 0.000 description 17
- 125000001424 substituent group Chemical group 0.000 description 17
- RTZKZFJDLAIYFH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Diethyl ether Chemical compound CCOCC RTZKZFJDLAIYFH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 15
- HEMHJVSKTPXQMS-UHFFFAOYSA-M Sodium hydroxide Chemical compound [OH-].[Na+] HEMHJVSKTPXQMS-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 15
- 208000036142 Viral infection Diseases 0.000 description 15
- 230000009385 viral infection Effects 0.000 description 15
- IAZDPXIOMUYVGZ-WFGJKAKNSA-N Dimethyl sulfoxide Chemical compound [2H]C([2H])([2H])S(=O)C([2H])([2H])[2H] IAZDPXIOMUYVGZ-WFGJKAKNSA-N 0.000 description 14
- WYURNTSHIVDZCO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Tetrahydrofuran Chemical compound C1CCOC1 WYURNTSHIVDZCO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 14
- 235000019441 ethanol Nutrition 0.000 description 14
- KDLHZDBZIXYQEI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Palladium Chemical compound [Pd] KDLHZDBZIXYQEI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 13
- 208000015181 infectious disease Diseases 0.000 description 13
- 125000001997 phenyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C([H])=C(*)C([H])=C1[H] 0.000 description 13
- XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N water Substances O XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 13
- YXFVVABEGXRONW-UHFFFAOYSA-N Toluene Chemical compound CC1=CC=CC=C1 YXFVVABEGXRONW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 12
- 239000003814 drug Substances 0.000 description 12
- 241000701044 Human gammaherpesvirus 4 Species 0.000 description 11
- SECXISVLQFMRJM-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-Methylpyrrolidone Chemical compound CN1CCCC1=O SECXISVLQFMRJM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 11
- 125000004432 carbon atom Chemical group C* 0.000 description 11
- 239000012442 inert solvent Substances 0.000 description 11
- 239000007788 liquid Substances 0.000 description 11
- UMJSCPRVCHMLSP-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyridine Natural products COC1=CC=CN=C1 UMJSCPRVCHMLSP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 11
- YLQBMQCUIZJEEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N tetrahydrofuran Natural products C=1C=COC=1 YLQBMQCUIZJEEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 11
- CSNNHWWHGAXBCP-UHFFFAOYSA-L Magnesium sulfate Chemical compound [Mg+2].[O-][S+2]([O-])([O-])[O-] CSNNHWWHGAXBCP-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 10
- 241000124008 Mammalia Species 0.000 description 10
- 239000004480 active ingredient Substances 0.000 description 10
- 230000003647 oxidation Effects 0.000 description 10
- 238000007254 oxidation reaction Methods 0.000 description 10
- 229910000027 potassium carbonate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 10
- 241000701085 Human alphaherpesvirus 3 Species 0.000 description 9
- 241000700605 Viruses Species 0.000 description 9
- 229910052799 carbon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 9
- OKTJSMMVPCPJKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N Carbon Chemical compound [C] OKTJSMMVPCPJKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 8
- 241000701022 Cytomegalovirus Species 0.000 description 8
- 241000701027 Human herpesvirus 6 Species 0.000 description 8
- KFZMGEQAYNKOFK-UHFFFAOYSA-N Isopropanol Chemical compound CC(C)O KFZMGEQAYNKOFK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 8
- RWRDLPDLKQPQOW-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pyrrolidine Chemical compound C1CCNC1 RWRDLPDLKQPQOW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 8
- 150000001412 amines Chemical class 0.000 description 8
- 238000010438 heat treatment Methods 0.000 description 8
- 208000037803 restenosis Diseases 0.000 description 8
- 239000003826 tablet Substances 0.000 description 8
- 125000002496 methyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 7
- 208000024891 symptom Diseases 0.000 description 7
- CYPYTURSJDMMMP-WVCUSYJESA-N (1e,4e)-1,5-diphenylpenta-1,4-dien-3-one;palladium Chemical compound [Pd].[Pd].C=1C=CC=CC=1\C=C\C(=O)\C=C\C1=CC=CC=C1.C=1C=CC=CC=1\C=C\C(=O)\C=C\C1=CC=CC=C1.C=1C=CC=CC=1\C=C\C(=O)\C=C\C1=CC=CC=C1 CYPYTURSJDMMMP-WVCUSYJESA-N 0.000 description 6
- 238000001644 13C nuclear magnetic resonance spectroscopy Methods 0.000 description 6
- OQUXOSORNZELRD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-[8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-a]pyridin-3-yl]-n-phenylpyrimidin-2-amine Chemical compound COC1=CC=CC(C2=C(N3C=CC=C(Cl)C3=N2)C=2N=C(NC=3C=CC=CC=3)N=CC=2)=C1 OQUXOSORNZELRD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- QTBSBXVTEAMEQO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Acetic acid Chemical compound CC(O)=O QTBSBXVTEAMEQO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- HEDRZPFGACZZDS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Chloroform Chemical compound ClC(Cl)Cl HEDRZPFGACZZDS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- KCXVZYZYPLLWCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N EDTA Chemical compound OC(=O)CN(CC(O)=O)CCN(CC(O)=O)CC(O)=O KCXVZYZYPLLWCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 208000029433 Herpesviridae infectious disease Diseases 0.000 description 6
- 241000701041 Human betaherpesvirus 7 Species 0.000 description 6
- TWRXJAOTZQYOKJ-UHFFFAOYSA-L Magnesium chloride Chemical compound [Mg+2].[Cl-].[Cl-] TWRXJAOTZQYOKJ-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 6
- YNAVUWVOSKDBBP-UHFFFAOYSA-N Morpholine Chemical compound C1COCCN1 YNAVUWVOSKDBBP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- NQRYJNQNLNOLGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N Piperidine Chemical compound C1CCNCC1 NQRYJNQNLNOLGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 239000002253 acid Substances 0.000 description 6
- 239000003795 chemical substances by application Substances 0.000 description 6
- RAXXELZNTBOGNW-UHFFFAOYSA-N imidazole Natural products C1=CNC=N1 RAXXELZNTBOGNW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 201000006747 infectious mononucleosis Diseases 0.000 description 6
- NUJOXMJBOLGQSY-UHFFFAOYSA-N manganese dioxide Chemical compound O=[Mn]=O NUJOXMJBOLGQSY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 201000006417 multiple sclerosis Diseases 0.000 description 6
- QJZUKDFHGGYHMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyridine-3-carbaldehyde Chemical compound O=CC1=CC=CN=C1 QJZUKDFHGGYHMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- RZJPBQGRCNJYBU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-chloropyridin-2-amine Chemical compound NC1=NC=CC=C1Cl RZJPBQGRCNJYBU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 206010008874 Chronic Fatigue Syndrome Diseases 0.000 description 5
- 241000700721 Hepatitis B virus Species 0.000 description 5
- 208000007514 Herpes zoster Diseases 0.000 description 5
- 238000002399 angioplasty Methods 0.000 description 5
- 238000003556 assay Methods 0.000 description 5
- 239000000969 carrier Substances 0.000 description 5
- 239000000499 gel Substances 0.000 description 5
- 239000004615 ingredient Substances 0.000 description 5
- 229910052943 magnesium sulfate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 5
- 235000019341 magnesium sulphate Nutrition 0.000 description 5
- 208000029766 myalgic encephalomeyelitis/chronic fatigue syndrome Diseases 0.000 description 5
- XHXFXVLFKHQFAL-UHFFFAOYSA-N phosphoryl trichloride Chemical compound ClP(Cl)(Cl)=O XHXFXVLFKHQFAL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 239000000843 powder Substances 0.000 description 5
- 239000000725 suspension Substances 0.000 description 5
- 125000003396 thiol group Chemical group [H]S* 0.000 description 5
- 241001529453 unidentified herpesvirus Species 0.000 description 5
- 201000001320 Atherosclerosis Diseases 0.000 description 4
- 241001502974 Human gammaherpesvirus 8 Species 0.000 description 4
- 241000725303 Human immunodeficiency virus Species 0.000 description 4
- 241000701806 Human papillomavirus Species 0.000 description 4
- 235000010643 Leucaena leucocephala Nutrition 0.000 description 4
- 240000007472 Leucaena leucocephala Species 0.000 description 4
- 206010028980 Neoplasm Diseases 0.000 description 4
- GLUUGHFHXGJENI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Piperazine Chemical compound C1CNCCN1 GLUUGHFHXGJENI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- KAESVJOAVNADME-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pyrrole Chemical compound C=1C=CNC=1 KAESVJOAVNADME-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silicium dioxide Chemical compound O=[Si]=O VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- QAOWNCQODCNURD-UHFFFAOYSA-N Sulfuric acid Chemical compound OS(O)(=O)=O QAOWNCQODCNURD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- YTPLMLYBLZKORZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Thiophene Chemical compound C=1C=CSC=1 YTPLMLYBLZKORZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 150000001298 alcohols Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 125000002947 alkylene group Chemical group 0.000 description 4
- 239000012267 brine Substances 0.000 description 4
- 125000001246 bromo group Chemical group Br* 0.000 description 4
- 239000002775 capsule Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000011203 carbon fibre reinforced carbon Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000003054 catalyst Substances 0.000 description 4
- NKLCNNUWBJBICK-UHFFFAOYSA-N dess–martin periodinane Chemical compound C1=CC=C2I(OC(=O)C)(OC(C)=O)(OC(C)=O)OC(=O)C2=C1 NKLCNNUWBJBICK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 239000000839 emulsion Substances 0.000 description 4
- 150000002148 esters Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 239000012091 fetal bovine serum Substances 0.000 description 4
- 229910052744 lithium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- ZTIGLNXZTZDSSR-UHFFFAOYSA-N n-cyclopentyl-3-[2-(cyclopentylamino)pyrimidin-4-yl]-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-a]pyridin-8-amine Chemical compound COC1=CC=CC(C2=C(N3C=CC=C(NC4CCCC4)C3=N2)C=2N=C(NC3CCCC3)N=CC=2)=C1 ZTIGLNXZTZDSSR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 239000007800 oxidant agent Substances 0.000 description 4
- 229910052760 oxygen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 229920001223 polyethylene glycol Polymers 0.000 description 4
- 230000035755 proliferation Effects 0.000 description 4
- 210000000329 smooth muscle myocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 4
- 239000011734 sodium Substances 0.000 description 4
- 229910052708 sodium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- MFRIHAYPQRLWNB-UHFFFAOYSA-N sodium tert-butoxide Chemical compound [Na+].CC(C)(C)[O-] MFRIHAYPQRLWNB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- HPALAKNZSZLMCH-UHFFFAOYSA-M sodium;chloride;hydrate Chemical compound O.[Na+].[Cl-] HPALAKNZSZLMCH-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 4
- 238000001356 surgical procedure Methods 0.000 description 4
- 238000003786 synthesis reaction Methods 0.000 description 4
- 229940124597 therapeutic agent Drugs 0.000 description 4
- 230000003612 virological effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 125000006595 (C1-C3) alkylsulfinyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 125000004178 (C1-C4) alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- RYHBNJHYFVUHQT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,4-Dioxane Chemical compound C1COCCO1 RYHBNJHYFVUHQT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- VTOOZFQVXOJABX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-[8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-a]pyridin-3-yl]prop-2-yn-1-ol Chemical compound COC1=CC=CC(C2=C(N3C=CC=C(Cl)C3=N2)C(O)C#C)=C1 VTOOZFQVXOJABX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- FCVAIGOUJICJIM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-[8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-a]pyridin-3-yl]prop-2-yn-1-one Chemical compound COC1=CC=CC(C2=C(N3C=CC=C(Cl)C3=N2)C(=O)C#C)=C1 FCVAIGOUJICJIM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 238000004293 19F NMR spectroscopy Methods 0.000 description 3
- KTKDJZBVFCEFIT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-(4-fluorophenyl)guanidine;nitric acid Chemical compound O[N+]([O-])=O.NC(N)=NC1=CC=C(F)C=C1 KTKDJZBVFCEFIT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 125000000339 4-pyridyl group Chemical group N1=C([H])C([H])=C([*])C([H])=C1[H] 0.000 description 3
- JZWUYNXAHCJPKA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-a]pyridine Chemical compound COC1=CC=CC(C=2N=C3C(Cl)=CC=CN3C=2)=C1 JZWUYNXAHCJPKA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- ZAUIKVNXXIUXMP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-a]pyridine-3-carbaldehyde Chemical compound COC1=CC=CC(C2=C(N3C=CC=C(Cl)C3=N2)C=O)=C1 ZAUIKVNXXIUXMP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- WFDIJRYMOXRFFG-UHFFFAOYSA-N Acetic anhydride Chemical group CC(=O)OC(C)=O WFDIJRYMOXRFFG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- WEVYAHXRMPXWCK-UHFFFAOYSA-N Acetonitrile Chemical compound CC#N WEVYAHXRMPXWCK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 208000024172 Cardiovascular disease Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 108010010803 Gelatin Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 241000711557 Hepacivirus Species 0.000 description 3
- 208000009889 Herpes Simplex Diseases 0.000 description 3
- PAYRUJLWNCNPSJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-phenyl amine Natural products NC1=CC=CC=C1 PAYRUJLWNCNPSJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- PXHVJJICTQNCMI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Nickel Chemical compound [Ni] PXHVJJICTQNCMI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 239000002202 Polyethylene glycol Substances 0.000 description 3
- DNIAPMSPPWPWGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N Propylene glycol Chemical compound CC(O)CO DNIAPMSPPWPWGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- FZWLAAWBMGSTSO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Thiazole Chemical group C1=CSC=N1 FZWLAAWBMGSTSO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- DHKHKXVYLBGOIT-UHFFFAOYSA-N acetaldehyde Diethyl Acetal Natural products CCOC(C)OCC DHKHKXVYLBGOIT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 150000001241 acetals Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 239000003377 acid catalyst Substances 0.000 description 3
- 125000003545 alkoxy group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 150000003973 alkyl amines Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 125000005189 alkyl hydroxy group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 238000005804 alkylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 150000001409 amidines Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 150000003927 aminopyridines Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 150000001448 anilines Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 210000004204 blood vessel Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 229910052794 bromium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 239000000872 buffer Substances 0.000 description 3
- FJDQFPXHSGXQBY-UHFFFAOYSA-L caesium carbonate Chemical compound [Cs+].[Cs+].[O-]C([O-])=O FJDQFPXHSGXQBY-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 3
- 229910000024 caesium carbonate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- XECUWUAEUHETRK-UHFFFAOYSA-O carbamimidoyl(phenyl)azanium;nitrate Chemical compound [O-][N+]([O-])=O.NC(N)=[NH+]C1=CC=CC=C1 XECUWUAEUHETRK-UHFFFAOYSA-O 0.000 description 3
- 210000004027 cell Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 125000001309 chloro group Chemical group Cl* 0.000 description 3
- 238000009833 condensation Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000005494 condensation Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000007796 conventional method Methods 0.000 description 3
- 125000000000 cycloalkoxy group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- SUYVUBYJARFZHO-RRKCRQDMSA-N dATP Chemical compound C1=NC=2C(N)=NC=NC=2N1[C@H]1C[C@H](O)[C@@H](COP(O)(=O)OP(O)(=O)OP(O)(O)=O)O1 SUYVUBYJARFZHO-RRKCRQDMSA-N 0.000 description 3
- HAAZLUGHYHWQIW-KVQBGUIXSA-N dGTP Chemical compound C1=NC=2C(=O)NC(N)=NC=2N1[C@H]1C[C@H](O)[C@@H](COP(O)(=O)OP(O)(=O)OP(O)(O)=O)O1 HAAZLUGHYHWQIW-KVQBGUIXSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 238000001514 detection method Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000001914 filtration Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000003818 flash chromatography Methods 0.000 description 3
- 125000001153 fluoro group Chemical group F* 0.000 description 3
- 239000012458 free base Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000008273 gelatin Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229920000159 gelatin Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 235000019322 gelatine Nutrition 0.000 description 3
- 235000011852 gelatine desserts Nutrition 0.000 description 3
- 239000008187 granular material Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229910052736 halogen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 230000002140 halogenating effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 208000002672 hepatitis B Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 238000009396 hybridization Methods 0.000 description 3
- 150000002430 hydrocarbons Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- UTCSSFWDNNEEBH-UHFFFAOYSA-N imidazo[1,2-a]pyridine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC2=NC=CN21 UTCSSFWDNNEEBH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 239000003018 immunosuppressive agent Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000002347 injection Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000007924 injection Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000010410 layer Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229910001629 magnesium chloride Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- LROBJRRFCPYLIT-UHFFFAOYSA-M magnesium;ethyne;bromide Chemical compound [Mg+2].[Br-].[C-]#C LROBJRRFCPYLIT-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 3
- 238000002156 mixing Methods 0.000 description 3
- 229910052757 nitrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 239000003921 oil Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000012044 organic layer Substances 0.000 description 3
- SOWBFZRMHSNYGE-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxamic acid Chemical compound NC(=O)C(O)=O SOWBFZRMHSNYGE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 230000001590 oxidative effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 229910052763 palladium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- LIGACIXOYTUXAW-UHFFFAOYSA-N phenacyl bromide Chemical compound BrCC(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1 LIGACIXOYTUXAW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 239000002953 phosphate buffered saline Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000002265 prevention Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000000523 sample Substances 0.000 description 3
- 235000010356 sorbitol Nutrition 0.000 description 3
- 239000000600 sorbitol Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229940124530 sulfonamide Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 150000003456 sulfonamides Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 229910052717 sulfur Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 238000002560 therapeutic procedure Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000011135 tin Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000009466 transformation Effects 0.000 description 3
- 125000002023 trifluoromethyl group Chemical group FC(F)(F)* 0.000 description 3
- 125000004455 (C1-C3) alkylthio group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- WCFAPJDPAPDDAQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2-dihydropyrimidine Chemical compound C1NC=CC=N1 WCFAPJDPAPDDAQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- FCEHBMOGCRZNNI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-benzothiophene Chemical compound C1=CC=C2SC=CC2=C1 FCEHBMOGCRZNNI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- HZNVUJQVZSTENZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,3-dichloro-5,6-dicyano-1,4-benzoquinone Chemical compound ClC1=C(Cl)C(=O)C(C#N)=C(C#N)C1=O HZNVUJQVZSTENZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 241000416162 Astragalus gummifer Species 0.000 description 2
- WKBOTKDWSSQWDR-UHFFFAOYSA-N Bromine atom Chemical compound [Br] WKBOTKDWSSQWDR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- KPQBYYRRKSDKGL-UHFFFAOYSA-N C.COCC1CC1 Chemical compound C.COCC1CC1 KPQBYYRRKSDKGL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- UKSGUAJRVRJVFT-UHFFFAOYSA-N CC.CC.CC1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21 Chemical compound CC.CC.CC1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21 UKSGUAJRVRJVFT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 201000006082 Chickenpox Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 206010056489 Coronary artery restenosis Diseases 0.000 description 2
- XZMCDFZZKTWFGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N Cyanamide Chemical compound NC#N XZMCDFZZKTWFGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 206010011831 Cytomegalovirus infection Diseases 0.000 description 2
- FBPFZTCFMRRESA-FSIIMWSLSA-N D-Glucitol Natural products OC[C@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)CO FBPFZTCFMRRESA-FSIIMWSLSA-N 0.000 description 2
- AHCYMLUZIRLXAA-SHYZEUOFSA-N Deoxyuridine 5'-triphosphate Chemical compound O1[C@H](COP(O)(=O)OP(O)(=O)OP(O)(O)=O)[C@@H](O)C[C@@H]1N1C(=O)NC(=O)C=C1 AHCYMLUZIRLXAA-SHYZEUOFSA-N 0.000 description 2
- OKKJLVBELUTLKV-MZCSYVLQSA-N Deuterated methanol Chemical compound [2H]OC([2H])([2H])[2H] OKKJLVBELUTLKV-MZCSYVLQSA-N 0.000 description 2
- SHIBSTMRCDJXLN-UHFFFAOYSA-N Digoxigenin Natural products C1CC(C2C(C3(C)CCC(O)CC3CC2)CC2O)(O)C2(C)C1C1=CC(=O)OC1 SHIBSTMRCDJXLN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- IAZDPXIOMUYVGZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Dimethylsulphoxide Chemical compound CS(C)=O IAZDPXIOMUYVGZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 206010015108 Epstein-Barr virus infection Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 108010037362 Extracellular Matrix Proteins Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 102000010834 Extracellular Matrix Proteins Human genes 0.000 description 2
- PEDCQBHIVMGVHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Glycerine Chemical compound OCC(O)CO PEDCQBHIVMGVHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- ZRALSGWEFCBTJO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Guanidine Chemical compound NC(N)=N ZRALSGWEFCBTJO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 208000001688 Herpes Genitalis Diseases 0.000 description 2
- VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hydrochloric acid Chemical compound Cl VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 206010061598 Immunodeficiency Diseases 0.000 description 2
- SIKJAQJRHWYJAI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Indole Chemical compound C1=CC=C2NC=CC2=C1 SIKJAQJRHWYJAI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- XEEYBQQBJWHFJM-UHFFFAOYSA-N Iron Chemical compound [Fe] XEEYBQQBJWHFJM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000002841 Lewis acid Substances 0.000 description 2
- WHXSMMKQMYFTQS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Lithium Chemical compound [Li] WHXSMMKQMYFTQS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 208000030289 Lymphoproliferative disease Diseases 0.000 description 2
- AFVFQIVMOAPDHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Methanesulfonic acid Chemical compound CS(O)(=O)=O AFVFQIVMOAPDHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- PCLIMKBDDGJMGD-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-bromosuccinimide Chemical compound BrN1C(=O)CCC1=O PCLIMKBDDGJMGD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- JRNVZBWKYDBUCA-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-chlorosuccinimide Chemical compound ClN1C(=O)CCC1=O JRNVZBWKYDBUCA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- LQZMLBORDGWNPD-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-iodosuccinimide Chemical compound IN1C(=O)CCC1=O LQZMLBORDGWNPD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- GRYLNZFGIOXLOG-UHFFFAOYSA-N Nitric acid Chemical compound O[N+]([O-])=O GRYLNZFGIOXLOG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229920001213 Polysorbate 20 Polymers 0.000 description 2
- KYQCOXFCLRTKLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pyrazine Chemical compound C1=CN=CC=N1 KYQCOXFCLRTKLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- WTKZEGDFNFYCGP-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pyrazole Chemical compound C=1C=NNC=1 WTKZEGDFNFYCGP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 206010037660 Pyrexia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- CZPWVGJYEJSRLH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pyrimidine Chemical compound C1=CN=CN=C1 CZPWVGJYEJSRLH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- SMWDFEZZVXVKRB-UHFFFAOYSA-N Quinoline Chemical compound N1=CC=CC2=CC=CC=C21 SMWDFEZZVXVKRB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 206010038910 Retinitis Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 241000700584 Simplexvirus Species 0.000 description 2
- CDBYLPFSWZWCQE-UHFFFAOYSA-L Sodium Carbonate Chemical compound [Na+].[Na+].[O-]C([O-])=O CDBYLPFSWZWCQE-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 2
- FAPWRFPIFSIZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-M Sodium chloride Chemical compound [Na+].[Cl-] FAPWRFPIFSIZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 2
- CZMRCDWAGMRECN-UGDNZRGBSA-N Sucrose Chemical compound O[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@@]1(CO)O[C@@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O1 CZMRCDWAGMRECN-UGDNZRGBSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229930006000 Sucrose Natural products 0.000 description 2
- 238000006859 Swern oxidation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229920001615 Tragacanth Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 206010046980 Varicella Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 238000005874 Vilsmeier-Haack formylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 208000027418 Wounds and injury Diseases 0.000 description 2
- HCHKCACWOHOZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N Zinc Chemical compound [Zn] HCHKCACWOHOZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 150000007513 acids Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 230000010933 acylation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000005917 acylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 150000001299 aldehydes Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 125000004183 alkoxy alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- LFVGISIMTYGQHF-UHFFFAOYSA-N ammonium dihydrogen phosphate Chemical compound [NH4+].OP(O)([O-])=O LFVGISIMTYGQHF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000002619 bicyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- MUALRAIOVNYAIW-UHFFFAOYSA-N binap Chemical group C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C(=C2C=CC=CC2=CC=1)C=1C2=CC=CC=C2C=CC=1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 MUALRAIOVNYAIW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- YNHIGQDRGKUECZ-UHFFFAOYSA-L bis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(ii) dichloride Chemical compound [Cl-].[Cl-].[Pd+2].C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1.C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 YNHIGQDRGKUECZ-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 2
- 210000001185 bone marrow Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 230000004097 bone metabolism Effects 0.000 description 2
- ILAHWRKJUDSMFH-UHFFFAOYSA-N boron tribromide Chemical compound BrB(Br)Br ILAHWRKJUDSMFH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- GDTBXPJZTBHREO-UHFFFAOYSA-N bromine Substances BrBr GDTBXPJZTBHREO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000013592 cell lysate Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000003153 chemical reaction reagent Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000000460 chlorine Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910052801 chlorine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 230000007012 clinical effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229940110456 cocoa butter Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 235000019868 cocoa butter Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 208000029078 coronary artery disease Diseases 0.000 description 2
- NISGSNTVMOOSJQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N cyclopentanamine Chemical compound NC1CCCC1 NISGSNTVMOOSJQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- SUYVUBYJARFZHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N dATP Natural products C1=NC=2C(N)=NC=NC=2N1C1CC(O)C(COP(O)(=O)OP(O)(=O)OP(O)(O)=O)O1 SUYVUBYJARFZHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- RGWHQCVHVJXOKC-SHYZEUOFSA-J dCTP(4-) Chemical compound O=C1N=C(N)C=CN1[C@@H]1O[C@H](COP([O-])(=O)OP([O-])(=O)OP([O-])([O-])=O)[C@@H](O)C1 RGWHQCVHVJXOKC-SHYZEUOFSA-J 0.000 description 2
- 230000006378 damage Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000010520 demethylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000012631 diagnostic technique Methods 0.000 description 2
- QONQRTHLHBTMGP-UHFFFAOYSA-N digitoxigenin Natural products CC12CCC(C3(CCC(O)CC3CC3)C)C3C11OC1CC2C1=CC(=O)OC1 QONQRTHLHBTMGP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- SHIBSTMRCDJXLN-KCZCNTNESA-N digoxigenin Chemical compound C1([C@@H]2[C@@]3([C@@](CC2)(O)[C@H]2[C@@H]([C@@]4(C)CC[C@H](O)C[C@H]4CC2)C[C@H]3O)C)=CC(=O)OC1 SHIBSTMRCDJXLN-KCZCNTNESA-N 0.000 description 2
- IJKVHSBPTUYDLN-UHFFFAOYSA-N dihydroxy(oxo)silane Chemical compound O[Si](O)=O IJKVHSBPTUYDLN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 231100000676 disease causative agent Toxicity 0.000 description 2
- 238000007876 drug discovery Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000002500 effect on skin Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000000694 effects Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000000132 electrospray ionisation Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000008030 elimination Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000003379 elimination reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000001704 evaporation Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000008020 evaporation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 210000002744 extracellular matrix Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 201000004946 genital herpes Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 238000005658 halogenation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 150000002367 halogens Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 235000015220 hamburgers Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 229940094991 herring sperm dna Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 125000002887 hydroxy group Chemical group [H]O* 0.000 description 2
- 150000002466 imines Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 210000000987 immune system Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 229940124589 immunosuppressive drug Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 238000001727 in vivo Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000011065 in-situ storage Methods 0.000 description 2
- 208000014674 injury Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 229910052740 iodine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 125000002346 iodo group Chemical group I* 0.000 description 2
- 125000001449 isopropyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 2
- AWJUIBRHMBBTKR-UHFFFAOYSA-N isoquinoline Chemical compound C1=NC=CC2=CC=CC=C21 AWJUIBRHMBBTKR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 150000002576 ketones Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 210000003734 kidney Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 150000007517 lewis acids Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 239000003446 ligand Substances 0.000 description 2
- HQKMJHAJHXVSDF-UHFFFAOYSA-L magnesium stearate Chemical compound [Mg+2].CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC([O-])=O.CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC([O-])=O HQKMJHAJHXVSDF-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 2
- 239000011159 matrix material Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000002950 monocyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 238000000465 moulding Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229910017604 nitric acid Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000002773 nucleotide Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000003729 nucleotide group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 235000019198 oils Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- LXNAVEXFUKBNMK-UHFFFAOYSA-N palladium(II) acetate Substances [Pd].CC(O)=O.CC(O)=O LXNAVEXFUKBNMK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- YJVFFLUZDVXJQI-UHFFFAOYSA-L palladium(ii) acetate Chemical compound [Pd+2].CC([O-])=O.CC([O-])=O YJVFFLUZDVXJQI-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 2
- NFHFRUOZVGFOOS-UHFFFAOYSA-N palladium;triphenylphosphane Chemical compound [Pd].C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1.C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1.C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1.C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 NFHFRUOZVGFOOS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000006072 paste Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000000546 pharmaceutical excipient Substances 0.000 description 2
- BASFCYQUMIYNBI-UHFFFAOYSA-N platinum Chemical compound [Pt] BASFCYQUMIYNBI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 235000010486 polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurate Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 239000000256 polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurate Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000000047 product Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000000306 recurrent effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000009467 reduction Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000006722 reduction reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000010992 reflux Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000003419 rna directed dna polymerase inhibitor Substances 0.000 description 2
- UCSJYZPVAKXKNQ-HZYVHMACSA-N streptomycin Chemical compound CN[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](CO)O[C@H]1O[C@@H]1[C@](C=O)(O)[C@H](C)O[C@H]1O[C@@H]1[C@@H](NC(N)=N)[C@H](O)[C@@H](NC(N)=N)[C@H](O)[C@H]1O UCSJYZPVAKXKNQ-HZYVHMACSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000005720 sucrose Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000000829 suppository Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000001629 suppression Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000000375 suspending agent Substances 0.000 description 2
- 235000020357 syrup Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 239000006188 syrup Substances 0.000 description 2
- VZGDMQKNWNREIO-UHFFFAOYSA-N tetrachloromethane Chemical compound ClC(Cl)(Cl)Cl VZGDMQKNWNREIO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000004809 thin layer chromatography Methods 0.000 description 2
- BRNULMACUQOKMR-UHFFFAOYSA-N thiomorpholine Chemical compound C1CSCCN1 BRNULMACUQOKMR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229930192474 thiophene Natural products 0.000 description 2
- 210000001519 tissue Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 230000000699 topical effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 235000010487 tragacanth Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 239000000196 tragacanth Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229940116362 tragacanth Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 238000000844 transformation Methods 0.000 description 2
- CSRZQMIRAZTJOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N trimethylsilyl iodide Chemical compound C[Si](C)(C)I CSRZQMIRAZTJOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910052725 zinc Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000011701 zinc Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000006545 (C1-C9) alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 125000006705 (C5-C7) cycloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- DNRSBCADLTZFHT-UHFFFAOYSA-N *.B.CC.CC.CC.CC.CNC1=NC=CC(C)=N1 Chemical compound *.B.CC.CC.CC.CC.CNC1=NC=CC(C)=N1 DNRSBCADLTZFHT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- SCYULBFZEHDVBN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,1-Dichloroethane Chemical compound CC(Cl)Cl SCYULBFZEHDVBN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZORQXIQZAOLNGE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,1-difluorocyclohexane Chemical compound FC1(F)CCCCC1 ZORQXIQZAOLNGE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OTPDWCMLUKMQNO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2,3,4-tetrahydropyrimidine Chemical compound C1NCC=CN1 OTPDWCMLUKMQNO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VDFVNEFVBPFDSB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,3-dioxane Chemical compound C1COCOC1 VDFVNEFVBPFDSB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WNXJIVFYUVYPPR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,3-dioxolane Chemical compound C1COCO1 WNXJIVFYUVYPPR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OGYGFUAIIOPWQD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,3-thiazolidine Chemical compound C1CSCN1 OGYGFUAIIOPWQD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IIZPXYDJLKNOIY-JXPKJXOSSA-N 1-palmitoyl-2-arachidonoyl-sn-glycero-3-phosphocholine Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC(=O)OC[C@H](COP([O-])(=O)OCC[N+](C)(C)C)OC(=O)CCC\C=C/C\C=C/C\C=C/C\C=C/CCCCC IIZPXYDJLKNOIY-JXPKJXOSSA-N 0.000 description 1
- BAXOFTOLAUCFNW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1H-indazole Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C=NNC2=C1 BAXOFTOLAUCFNW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- SBPIDKODQVLBGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1h-imidazole;pyridine Chemical group C1=CNC=N1.C1=CC=NC=C1 SBPIDKODQVLBGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MAKFMOSBBNKPMS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,3-dichloropyridine Chemical compound ClC1=CC=CN=C1Cl MAKFMOSBBNKPMS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KZDCMKVLEYCGQX-UDPGNSCCSA-N 2-(diethylamino)ethyl 4-aminobenzoate;(2s,5r,6r)-3,3-dimethyl-7-oxo-6-[(2-phenylacetyl)amino]-4-thia-1-azabicyclo[3.2.0]heptane-2-carboxylic acid;hydrate Chemical compound O.CCN(CC)CCOC(=O)C1=CC=C(N)C=C1.N([C@H]1[C@H]2SC([C@@H](N2C1=O)C(O)=O)(C)C)C(=O)CC1=CC=CC=C1 KZDCMKVLEYCGQX-UDPGNSCCSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VLEIUWBSEKKKFX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-amino-2-(hydroxymethyl)propane-1,3-diol;2-[2-[bis(carboxymethyl)amino]ethyl-(carboxymethyl)amino]acetic acid Chemical compound OCC(N)(CO)CO.OC(=O)CN(CC(O)=O)CCN(CC(O)=O)CC(O)=O VLEIUWBSEKKKFX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IOOHBIFQNQQUFI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-bromo-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)ethanone Chemical compound COC1=CC=CC(C(=O)CBr)=C1 IOOHBIFQNQQUFI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- GZHPNIQBPGUSSX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-bromo-1-(3-nitrophenyl)ethanone Chemical compound [O-][N+](=O)C1=CC=CC(C(=O)CBr)=C1 GZHPNIQBPGUSSX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KRVGXFREOJHJAX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-bromo-1-(4-methylphenyl)ethanone Chemical compound CC1=CC=C(C(=O)CBr)C=C1 KRVGXFREOJHJAX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000004200 2-methoxyethyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])OC([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- MGADZUXDNSDTHW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2H-pyran Chemical compound C1OC=CC=C1 MGADZUXDNSDTHW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KRZCOLNOCZKSDF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-fluoroaniline Chemical compound NC1=CC=C(F)C=C1 KRZCOLNOCZKSDF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- JYCQQPHGFMYQCF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-tert-Octylphenol monoethoxylate Chemical compound CC(C)(C)CC(C)(C)C1=CC=C(OCCO)C=C1 JYCQQPHGFMYQCF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZCYVEMRRCGMTRW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 7553-56-2 Chemical compound [I] ZCYVEMRRCGMTRW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- HBAQYPYDRFILMT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 8-[3-(1-cyclopropylpyrazol-4-yl)-1H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-5-yl]-3-methyl-3,8-diazabicyclo[3.2.1]octan-2-one Chemical class C1(CC1)N1N=CC(=C1)C1=NNC2=C1N=C(N=C2)N1C2C(N(CC1CC2)C)=O HBAQYPYDRFILMT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 208000030507 AIDS Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000004998 Abdominal Pain Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 235000019489 Almond oil Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 208000024827 Alzheimer disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- USFZMSVCRYTOJT-UHFFFAOYSA-N Ammonium acetate Chemical compound N.CC(O)=O USFZMSVCRYTOJT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VHUUQVKOLVNVRT-UHFFFAOYSA-N Ammonium hydroxide Chemical compound [NH4+].[OH-] VHUUQVKOLVNVRT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000972773 Aulopiformes Species 0.000 description 1
- 201000004569 Blindness Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000006386 Bone Resorption Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108091003079 Bovine Serum Albumin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 208000011691 Burkitt lymphomas Diseases 0.000 description 1
- COVZYZSDYWQREU-UHFFFAOYSA-N Busulfan Chemical compound CS(=O)(=O)OCCCCOS(C)(=O)=O COVZYZSDYWQREU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OIOZWUDHKCFYAQ-UHFFFAOYSA-M C.C1=CC=C(C2=CN3C=CC=CC3=N2)C=C1.CC.CC.CC.CC.CC1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21.[V]I Chemical compound C.C1=CC=C(C2=CN3C=CC=CC3=N2)C=C1.CC.CC.CC.CC.CC1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21.[V]I OIOZWUDHKCFYAQ-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- WXJHMTANMDVQTL-UHFFFAOYSA-M C1=CC=C(C2=CN3C=CC=CC3=N2)C=C1.CC.CC.CC.CC.CC(=O)C1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21.[V].[V]I Chemical compound C1=CC=C(C2=CN3C=CC=CC3=N2)C=C1.CC.CC.CC.CC.CC(=O)C1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21.[V].[V]I WXJHMTANMDVQTL-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- XEYYVWDJARMNPG-UHFFFAOYSA-M C1=CC=C(C2=CN3C=CC=CC3=N2)C=C1.CC.CC.CC.CC.II.I[IH]I.NC1=CC=CC=N1.O=C(CBr)C1=CC=CC=C1.[V]I Chemical compound C1=CC=C(C2=CN3C=CC=CC3=N2)C=C1.CC.CC.CC.CC.II.I[IH]I.NC1=CC=CC=N1.O=C(CBr)C1=CC=CC=C1.[V]I XEYYVWDJARMNPG-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- QEVUTNGGKNMPOT-UHFFFAOYSA-J C1=CC=C(C2=CN3C=CC=CC3=N2)C=C1.CC.CC.CC.CC.I[V](I)I.[H]C(=O)C1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21.[V]I Chemical compound C1=CC=C(C2=CN3C=CC=CC3=N2)C=C1.CC.CC.CC.CC.I[V](I)I.[H]C(=O)C1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21.[V]I QEVUTNGGKNMPOT-UHFFFAOYSA-J 0.000 description 1
- TVBWBJUGAVTHNL-UHFFFAOYSA-N CC(=O)NC(C)[Y] Chemical compound CC(=O)NC(C)[Y] TVBWBJUGAVTHNL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KBPCCVWUMVGXGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N CC(C)CCCC(C)C Chemical compound CC(C)CCCC(C)C KBPCCVWUMVGXGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IQJFXKDLRYJBSM-UHFFFAOYSA-N CC(C)NCOC(C)C Chemical compound CC(C)NCOC(C)C IQJFXKDLRYJBSM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WDEVXRIFJZNMKM-UHFFFAOYSA-N CC(C)OCOC(C)C Chemical compound CC(C)OCOC(C)C WDEVXRIFJZNMKM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- GVEWYTDDGDYBOE-GVTWHDCOSA-M CC.CC.CC.CC.CC(=O)C1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21.CN(C)/C=C/C(=O)C1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21.CN(C)C(O[RaH])O[RaH].[V].[V]I Chemical compound CC.CC.CC.CC.CC(=O)C1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21.CN(C)/C=C/C(=O)C1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21.CN(C)C(O[RaH])O[RaH].[V].[V]I GVEWYTDDGDYBOE-GVTWHDCOSA-M 0.000 description 1
- RDGZQPIHUUAFHB-UAIOKUCGSA-N CC.CC.CN(C)/C=C/C(=O)C1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21 Chemical compound CC.CC.CN(C)/C=C/C(=O)C1=C(C2=CC=CC=C2)N=C2C=CC=CN21 RDGZQPIHUUAFHB-UAIOKUCGSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CSKGIVSMOVXAHS-UHFFFAOYSA-N CC1=CC=C(C2=C(C3=CC=NC(NC4=CC=CC=C4)=N3)N3C=CC=C(Cl)C3=N2)C=C1 Chemical compound CC1=CC=C(C2=C(C3=CC=NC(NC4=CC=CC=C4)=N3)N3C=CC=C(Cl)C3=N2)C=C1 CSKGIVSMOVXAHS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- LSNUOELZFIWSMA-UHFFFAOYSA-N CC1=CC=C(C2=C(C3=CC=NC(NC4=CC=CC=C4)=N3)N3C=CC=C(NC4CCCC4)C3=N2)C=C1 Chemical compound CC1=CC=C(C2=C(C3=CC=NC(NC4=CC=CC=C4)=N3)N3C=CC=C(NC4CCCC4)C3=N2)C=C1 LSNUOELZFIWSMA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KETBCBSDCKFGPW-UHFFFAOYSA-N CCNCOC(C)C Chemical compound CCNCOC(C)C KETBCBSDCKFGPW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OYPRJOBELJOOCE-UHFFFAOYSA-N Calcium Chemical compound [Ca] OYPRJOBELJOOCE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229920002134 Carboxymethyl cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 208000002177 Cataract Diseases 0.000 description 1
- ZAMOUSCENKQFHK-UHFFFAOYSA-N Chlorine atom Chemical compound [Cl] ZAMOUSCENKQFHK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 206010010071 Coma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010010356 Congenital anomaly Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010062343 Congenital infection Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010010904 Convulsion Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229920002261 Corn starch Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 108010024986 Cyclin-Dependent Kinase 2 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010025464 Cyclin-Dependent Kinase 4 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010025468 Cyclin-Dependent Kinase 6 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100036239 Cyclin-dependent kinase 2 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102100036252 Cyclin-dependent kinase 4 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102100026804 Cyclin-dependent kinase 6 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102000004127 Cytokines Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108090000695 Cytokines Proteins 0.000 description 1
- FBPFZTCFMRRESA-JGWLITMVSA-N D-glucitol Chemical compound OC[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](O)CO FBPFZTCFMRRESA-JGWLITMVSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000450599 DNA viruses Species 0.000 description 1
- BUDQDWGNQVEFAC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Dihydropyran Chemical compound C1COC=CC1 BUDQDWGNQVEFAC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PIICEJLVQHRZGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N Ethylenediamine Chemical compound NCCN PIICEJLVQHRZGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 208000010201 Exanthema Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000001860 Eye Infections Diseases 0.000 description 1
- PXGOKWXKJXAPGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Fluorine Chemical compound FF PXGOKWXKJXAPGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 208000018522 Gastrointestinal disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-GASJEMHNSA-N Glucose Natural products OC[C@H]1OC(O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H]1O WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-GASJEMHNSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 208000005794 Hairy Leukoplakia Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010019233 Headaches Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000004898 Herpes Labialis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000017604 Hodgkin disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000010747 Hodgkins lymphoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000282412 Homo Species 0.000 description 1
- 108010001336 Horseradish Peroxidase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- UFHFLCQGNIYNRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hydrogen Chemical compound [H][H] UFHFLCQGNIYNRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000004354 Hydroxyethyl cellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920000663 Hydroxyethyl cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- XQFRJNBWHJMXHO-RRKCRQDMSA-N IDUR Chemical group C1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@H]1N1C(=O)NC(=O)C(I)=C1 XQFRJNBWHJMXHO-RRKCRQDMSA-N 0.000 description 1
- DGAQECJNVWCQMB-PUAWFVPOSA-M Ilexoside XXIX Chemical compound C[C@@H]1CC[C@@]2(CC[C@@]3(C(=CC[C@H]4[C@]3(CC[C@@H]5[C@@]4(CC[C@@H](C5(C)C)OS(=O)(=O)[O-])C)C)[C@@H]2[C@]1(C)O)C)C(=O)O[C@H]6[C@@H]([C@H]([C@@H]([C@H](O6)CO)O)O)O.[Na+] DGAQECJNVWCQMB-PUAWFVPOSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 206010061218 Inflammation Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000029523 Interstitial Lung disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- QZRGKCOWNLSUDK-UHFFFAOYSA-N Iodochlorine Chemical compound ICl QZRGKCOWNLSUDK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VQTUBCCKSQIDNK-UHFFFAOYSA-N Isobutene Chemical group CC(C)=C VQTUBCCKSQIDNK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 206010023126 Jaundice Diseases 0.000 description 1
- ZDXPYRJPNDTMRX-VKHMYHEASA-N L-glutamine Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CCC(N)=O ZDXPYRJPNDTMRX-VKHMYHEASA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229930182816 L-glutamine Natural products 0.000 description 1
- GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-QKKXKWKRSA-N Lactose Natural products OC[C@H]1O[C@@H](O[C@H]2[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)C(O)O[C@@H]2CO)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H]1O GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-QKKXKWKRSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000004166 Lanolin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 208000032420 Latent Infection Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010024971 Lower respiratory tract infections Diseases 0.000 description 1
- FYYHWMGAXLPEAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N Magnesium Chemical compound [Mg] FYYHWMGAXLPEAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 235000019759 Maize starch Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 208000036626 Mental retardation Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229920000168 Microcrystalline cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000715 Mucilage Polymers 0.000 description 1
- FXHOOIRPVKKKFG-UHFFFAOYSA-N N,N-Dimethylacetamide Chemical compound CN(C)C(C)=O FXHOOIRPVKKKFG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZSXGLVDWWRXATF-UHFFFAOYSA-N N,N-dimethylformamide dimethyl acetal Chemical compound COC(OC)N(C)C ZSXGLVDWWRXATF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CHJJGSNFBQVOTG-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-methyl-guanidine Natural products CNC(N)=N CHJJGSNFBQVOTG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MBBZMMPHUWSWHV-BDVNFPICSA-N N-methylglucamine Chemical compound CNC[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](O)CO MBBZMMPHUWSWHV-BDVNFPICSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000005481 NMR spectroscopy Methods 0.000 description 1
- 208000002454 Nasopharyngeal Carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010061306 Nasopharyngeal cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010028813 Nausea Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000012902 Nervous system disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000025966 Neurological disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000015914 Non-Hodgkin lymphomas Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229940122313 Nucleoside reverse transcriptase inhibitor Drugs 0.000 description 1
- GDQWGRMPXASNTI-UHFFFAOYSA-N O=Cc1c(-c2ccccc2)nc2[n]1cccc2 Chemical compound O=Cc1c(-c2ccccc2)nc2[n]1cccc2 GDQWGRMPXASNTI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- QPOPODZKCFDSOK-UHFFFAOYSA-N O=[N+]([O-])C1=CC=CC(C2=C(C3=CC=NC(NC4=CC=C(F)C=C4)=N3)N3C=CC=C(Cl)C3=N2)=C1 Chemical compound O=[N+]([O-])C1=CC=CC(C2=C(C3=CC=NC(NC4=CC=C(F)C=C4)=N3)N3C=CC=C(Cl)C3=N2)=C1 QPOPODZKCFDSOK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 108700026244 Open Reading Frames Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010067152 Oral herpes Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000005141 Otitis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- ZCQWOFVYLHDMMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Oxazole Chemical compound C1=COC=N1 ZCQWOFVYLHDMMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WYNCHZVNFNFDNH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Oxazolidine Chemical compound C1COCN1 WYNCHZVNFNFDNH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 206010033799 Paralysis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- PCNDJXKNXGMECE-UHFFFAOYSA-N Phenazine Natural products C1=CC=CC2=NC3=CC=CC=C3N=C21 PCNDJXKNXGMECE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 206010035664 Pneumonia Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010035742 Pneumonitis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- ZLMJMSJWJFRBEC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Potassium Chemical compound [K] ZLMJMSJWJFRBEC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 206010037898 Rash vesicular Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108700026039 Simplexvirus UL13 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- KEAYESYHFKHZAL-UHFFFAOYSA-N Sodium Chemical compound [Na] KEAYESYHFKHZAL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UIIMBOGNXHQVGW-DEQYMQKBSA-M Sodium bicarbonate-14C Chemical compound [Na+].O[14C]([O-])=O UIIMBOGNXHQVGW-DEQYMQKBSA-M 0.000 description 1
- DBMJMQXJHONAFJ-UHFFFAOYSA-M Sodium laurylsulphate Chemical compound [Na+].CCCCCCCCCCCCOS([O-])(=O)=O DBMJMQXJHONAFJ-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 229920002472 Starch Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 235000021355 Stearic acid Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229910000831 Steel Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 101150048584 TRM3 gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- DHXVGJBLRPWPCS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Tetrahydropyran Chemical compound C1CCOCC1 DHXVGJBLRPWPCS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- YPWFISCTZQNZAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N Thiane Chemical compound C1CCSCC1 YPWFISCTZQNZAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ATJFFYVFTNAWJD-UHFFFAOYSA-N Tin Chemical compound [Sn] ATJFFYVFTNAWJD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910021626 Tin(II) chloride Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000007984 Tris EDTA buffer Substances 0.000 description 1
- YZCKVEUIGOORGS-NJFSPNSNSA-N Tritium Chemical compound [3H] YZCKVEUIGOORGS-NJFSPNSNSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 206010047700 Vomiting Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000033779 X-linked lymphoproliferative disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- MCGSCOLBFJQGHM-SCZZXKLOSA-N abacavir Chemical compound C=12N=CN([C@H]3C=C[C@@H](CO)C3)C2=NC(N)=NC=1NC1CC1 MCGSCOLBFJQGHM-SCZZXKLOSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960004748 abacavir Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000002159 abnormal effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001154 acute effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000006978 adaptation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000654 additive Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000853 adhesive Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000443 aerosol Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000003905 agrochemical Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000001447 alkali salts Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000001350 alkyl halides Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000008168 almond oil Substances 0.000 description 1
- HSFWRNGVRCDJHI-UHFFFAOYSA-N alpha-acetylene Natural products C#C HSFWRNGVRCDJHI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000004411 aluminium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052782 aluminium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N aluminium Chemical compound [Al] XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CEGOLXSVJUTHNZ-UHFFFAOYSA-K aluminium tristearate Chemical compound [Al+3].CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC([O-])=O.CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC([O-])=O.CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC([O-])=O CEGOLXSVJUTHNZ-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 1
- 229940063655 aluminum stearate Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 150000001408 amides Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 238000005576 amination reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000003277 amino group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 239000000908 ammonium hydroxide Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000003321 amplification Effects 0.000 description 1
- YMARZQAQMVYCKC-OEMFJLHTSA-N amprenavir Chemical compound C([C@@H]([C@H](O)CN(CC(C)C)S(=O)(=O)C=1C=CC(N)=CC=1)NC(=O)O[C@@H]1COCC1)C1=CC=CC=C1 YMARZQAQMVYCKC-OEMFJLHTSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960001830 amprenavir Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 208000022531 anorexia Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000003963 antioxidant agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000006708 antioxidants Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 238000005899 aromatization reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 150000001543 aryl boronic acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000012298 atmosphere Substances 0.000 description 1
- QVGXLLKOCUKJST-UHFFFAOYSA-N atomic oxygen Chemical group [O] QVGXLLKOCUKJST-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 210000003719 b-lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- RFRXIWQYSOIBDI-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzarone Chemical compound CCC=1OC2=CC=CC=C2C=1C(=O)C1=CC=C(O)C=C1 RFRXIWQYSOIBDI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- JUHORIMYRDESRB-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzathine Chemical compound C=1C=CC=CC=1CNCCNCC1=CC=CC=C1 JUHORIMYRDESRB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WPYMKLBDIGXBTP-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzoic acid group Chemical group C(C1=CC=CC=C1)(=O)O WPYMKLBDIGXBTP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000002527 bicyclic carbocyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 239000011230 binding agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000004071 biological effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000015572 biosynthetic process Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000004369 blood Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000008280 blood Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000024279 bone resorption Effects 0.000 description 1
- KDHWCFCNNGUJCP-UHFFFAOYSA-N c1c(-c2ccccc2)nc2[n]1cccc2 Chemical compound c1c(-c2ccccc2)nc2[n]1cccc2 KDHWCFCNNGUJCP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000011575 calcium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052791 calcium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000001506 calcium phosphate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910000389 calcium phosphate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 235000011010 calcium phosphates Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 201000011510 cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000001460 carbon-13 nuclear magnetic resonance spectrum Methods 0.000 description 1
- 235000010948 carboxy methyl cellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000001768 carboxy methyl cellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000008112 carboxymethyl-cellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000022131 cell cycle Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001413 cellular effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000003169 central nervous system Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 238000012512 characterization method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000000451 chemical ionisation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003638 chemical reducing agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000007910 chewable tablet Substances 0.000 description 1
- VDANGULDQQJODZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N chloroprocaine Chemical compound CCN(CC)CCOC(=O)C1=CC=C(N)C=C1Cl VDANGULDQQJODZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960002023 chloroprocaine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- OEYIOHPDSNJKLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N choline Chemical compound C[N+](C)(C)CCO OEYIOHPDSNJKLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960001231 choline Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000001684 chronic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000011248 coating agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000000576 coating method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003240 coconut oil Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000019864 coconut oil Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 238000004440 column chromatography Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007891 compressed tablet Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000007906 compression Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000006835 compression Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000013270 controlled release Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000036461 convulsion Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000004351 coronary vessel Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000006071 cream Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000005520 cutting process Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000001047 cyclobutenyl group Chemical group C1(=CCC1)* 0.000 description 1
- 125000001995 cyclobutyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000000582 cycloheptyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000000596 cyclohexenyl group Chemical group C1(=CCCCC1)* 0.000 description 1
- 125000000113 cyclohexyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000000640 cyclooctyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- KFGVRWGDTLZAAO-UHFFFAOYSA-N cyclopenta-1,3-diene dicyclohexyl(cyclopenta-1,3-dien-1-yl)phosphane iron(2+) Chemical compound [Fe++].c1cc[cH-]c1.C1CCC(CC1)P(C1CCCCC1)c1ccc[cH-]1 KFGVRWGDTLZAAO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000002433 cyclopentenyl group Chemical group C1(=CCCC1)* 0.000 description 1
- 125000001511 cyclopentyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000001559 cyclopropyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C1([H])* 0.000 description 1
- NHVNXKFIZYSCEB-XLPZGREQSA-N dTTP Chemical compound O=C1NC(=O)C(C)=CN1[C@@H]1O[C@H](COP(O)(=O)OP(O)(=O)OP(O)(O)=O)[C@@H](O)C1 NHVNXKFIZYSCEB-XLPZGREQSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000034994 death Effects 0.000 description 1
- 206010061428 decreased appetite Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000007812 deficiency Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003405 delayed action preparation Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000002939 deleterious effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000017858 demethylation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003599 detergent Substances 0.000 description 1
- ZBCBWPMODOFKDW-UHFFFAOYSA-N diethanolamine Chemical compound OCCNCCO ZBCBWPMODOFKDW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940043237 diethanolamine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- SWSQBOPZIKWTGO-UHFFFAOYSA-N dimethylaminoamidine Natural products CN(C)C(N)=N SWSQBOPZIKWTGO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- SXZIXHOMFPUIRK-UHFFFAOYSA-N diphenylmethanimine Chemical group C=1C=CC=CC=1C(=N)C1=CC=CC=C1 SXZIXHOMFPUIRK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- LOKCTEFSRHRXRJ-UHFFFAOYSA-I dipotassium trisodium dihydrogen phosphate hydrogen phosphate dichloride Chemical compound P(=O)(O)(O)[O-].[K+].P(=O)(O)([O-])[O-].[Na+].[Na+].[Cl-].[K+].[Cl-].[Na+] LOKCTEFSRHRXRJ-UHFFFAOYSA-I 0.000 description 1
- 229940042399 direct acting antivirals protease inhibitors Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 208000037771 disease arising from reactivation of latent virus Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000007884 disintegrant Substances 0.000 description 1
- 208000035475 disorder Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000009826 distribution Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000002552 dosage form Substances 0.000 description 1
- 208000019258 ear infection Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000008157 edible vegetable oil Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000002526 effect on cardiovascular system Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003995 emulsifying agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000007613 environmental effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000002919 epithelial cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- BEFDCLMNVWHSGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N ethenylcyclopentane Chemical compound C=CC1CCCC1 BEFDCLMNVWHSGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000005678 ethenylene group Chemical group [H]C([*:1])=C([H])[*:2] 0.000 description 1
- OAYLNYINCPYISS-UHFFFAOYSA-N ethyl acetate;hexane Chemical class CCCCCC.CCOC(C)=O OAYLNYINCPYISS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000001495 ethyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 229940012017 ethylenediamine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 125000002534 ethynyl group Chemical group [H]C#C* 0.000 description 1
- 201000005884 exanthem Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010016165 failure to thrive Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229960004396 famciclovir Drugs 0.000 description 1
- GGXKWVWZWMLJEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N famcyclovir Chemical compound N1=C(N)N=C2N(CCC(COC(=O)C)COC(C)=O)C=NC2=C1 GGXKWVWZWMLJEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000003925 fat Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000019197 fats Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000000945 filler Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000706 filtrate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000012467 final product Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000796 flavoring agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000011737 fluorine Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052731 fluorine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000006260 foam Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000013355 food flavoring agent Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000022244 formylation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000006170 formylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012634 fragment Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229960002963 ganciclovir Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000007789 gas Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000008570 general process Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000004392 genitalia Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000008103 glucose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000001727 glucose Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 125000005456 glyceride group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 235000011187 glycerol Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- PCHJSUWPFVWCPO-UHFFFAOYSA-N gold Chemical compound [Au] PCHJSUWPFVWCPO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052737 gold Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000010931 gold Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000012010 growth Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003102 growth factor Substances 0.000 description 1
- ZJYYHGLJYGJLLN-UHFFFAOYSA-N guanidinium thiocyanate Chemical compound SC#N.NC(N)=N ZJYYHGLJYGJLLN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000001475 halogen functional group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 230000026030 halogenation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940116364 hard fat Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 231100000869 headache Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 206010073071 hepatocellular carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 231100000844 hepatocellular carcinoma Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 206010019847 hepatosplenomegaly Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 150000002391 heterocyclic compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000003840 hydrochlorides Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000001257 hydrogen Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000004435 hydrogen atom Chemical group [H]* 0.000 description 1
- 230000007062 hydrolysis Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000006460 hydrolysis reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002209 hydrophobic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 235000019447 hydroxyethyl cellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- UWYVPFMHMJIBHE-OWOJBTEDSA-N hydroxymaleic acid group Chemical group O/C(/C(=O)O)=C/C(=O)O UWYVPFMHMJIBHE-OWOJBTEDSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000005234 imidazo[1,2-a]pyridines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 230000028993 immune response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000036039 immunity Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229960003444 immunosuppressant agent Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000001771 impaired effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000002513 implantation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000000338 in vitro Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000011534 incubation Methods 0.000 description 1
- PZOUSPYUWWUPPK-UHFFFAOYSA-N indole Natural products CC1=CC=CC2=C1C=CN2 PZOUSPYUWWUPPK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- RKJUIXBNRJVNHR-UHFFFAOYSA-N indolenine Natural products C1=CC=C2CC=NC2=C1 RKJUIXBNRJVNHR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000012678 infectious agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000004054 inflammatory process Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003112 inhibitor Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000005764 inhibitory process Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000007918 intramuscular administration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000010255 intramuscular injection Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007927 intramuscular injection Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000007913 intrathecal administration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000001990 intravenous administration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000011630 iodine Substances 0.000 description 1
- PNDPGZBMCMUPRI-UHFFFAOYSA-N iodine Chemical compound II PNDPGZBMCMUPRI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000003456 ion exchange resin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920003303 ion-exchange polymer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229910052742 iron Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 125000000959 isobutyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- ZLTPDFXIESTBQG-UHFFFAOYSA-N isothiazole Chemical compound C=1C=NSC=1 ZLTPDFXIESTBQG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CTAPFRYPJLPFDF-UHFFFAOYSA-N isoxazole Chemical compound C=1C=NOC=1 CTAPFRYPJLPFDF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 206010023332 keratitis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000008101 lactose Substances 0.000 description 1
- JTEGQNOMFQHVDC-NKWVEPMBSA-N lamivudine Chemical compound O=C1N=C(N)C=CN1[C@H]1O[C@@H](CO)SC1 JTEGQNOMFQHVDC-NKWVEPMBSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960001627 lamivudine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229940039717 lanolin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000019388 lanolin Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000002045 lasting effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 235000010445 lecithin Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000000787 lecithin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940067606 lecithin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000003902 lesion Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000011968 lewis acid catalyst Substances 0.000 description 1
- 201000007270 liver cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000019423 liver disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000014018 liver neoplasm Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000006210 lotion Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000007937 lozenge Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000314 lubricant Substances 0.000 description 1
- 210000004072 lung Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 210000002540 macrophage Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000011777 magnesium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052749 magnesium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 235000019359 magnesium stearate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 206010025482 malaise Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000036210 malignancy Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000003211 malignant effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000001819 mass spectrum Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000000463 material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000013160 medical therapy Methods 0.000 description 1
- 210000002418 meninge Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000002207 metabolite Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052751 metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000002184 metal Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000002739 metals Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229920000609 methyl cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 235000010270 methyl p-hydroxybenzoate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 235000010981 methylcellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000001923 methylcellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 208000004141 microcephaly Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 235000019813 microcrystalline cellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229940016286 microcrystalline cellulose Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000008108 microcrystalline cellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000005012 migration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000013508 migration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000002480 mineral oil Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000010446 mineral oil Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 150000007522 mineralic acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 230000004048 modification Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012986 modification Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000001620 monocyclic carbocycle group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 210000001616 monocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- DBNQIOANXZVWIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N n,n-dimethyl-1,1-bis[(2-methylpropan-2-yl)oxy]methanamine Chemical compound CC(C)(C)OC(N(C)C)OC(C)(C)C DBNQIOANXZVWIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000004108 n-butyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 125000000740 n-pentyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 125000004123 n-propyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 125000001624 naphthyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 201000011216 nasopharynx carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000008693 nausea Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005485 negative regulation of interleukin-1 production Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000009826 neoplastic cell growth Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000003061 neural cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 208000004296 neuralgia Diseases 0.000 description 1
- DIHKZQUSGDYVOT-UHFFFAOYSA-N nitric acid;2-phenylguanidine Chemical compound O[N+]([O-])=O.NC(N)=NC1=CC=CC=C1 DIHKZQUSGDYVOT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000004433 nitrogen atom Chemical group N* 0.000 description 1
- 239000002687 nonaqueous vehicle Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000003199 nucleic acid amplification method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000002777 nucleoside Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000003833 nucleoside derivatives Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- QIQXTHQIDYTFRH-UHFFFAOYSA-N octadecanoic acid Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC(O)=O QIQXTHQIDYTFRH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OQCDKBAXFALNLD-UHFFFAOYSA-N octadecanoic acid Natural products CCCCCCCC(C)CCCCCCCCC(O)=O OQCDKBAXFALNLD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000002674 ointment Substances 0.000 description 1
- 206010030979 oral hairy leukoplakia Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 210000000056 organ Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 150000007524 organic acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 235000005985 organic acids Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- WCPAKWJPBJAGKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxadiazole Chemical compound C1=CON=N1 WCPAKWJPBJAGKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000002971 oxazolyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- AHHWIHXENZJRFG-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxetane Chemical compound C1COC1 AHHWIHXENZJRFG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000001301 oxygen Substances 0.000 description 1
- PIBWKRNGBLPSSY-UHFFFAOYSA-L palladium(II) chloride Chemical compound Cl[Pd]Cl PIBWKRNGBLPSSY-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- 238000007911 parenteral administration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 235000010603 pastilles Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000035515 penetration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000137 peptide hydrolase inhibitor Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000002085 persistent effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 235000019271 petrolatum Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- WLJVXDMOQOGPHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N phenylacetic acid Chemical compound OC(=O)CC1=CC=CC=C1 WLJVXDMOQOGPHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000013612 plasmid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052697 platinum Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229940068917 polyethylene glycols Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000001267 polyvinylpyrrolidone Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920000036 polyvinylpyrrolidone Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 235000013855 polyvinylpyrrolidone Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000011591 potassium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052700 potassium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229920001592 potato starch Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 230000035935 pregnancy Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003755 preservative agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 208000037920 primary disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- MFDFERRIHVXMIY-UHFFFAOYSA-N procaine Chemical class CCN(CC)CCOC(=O)C1=CC=C(N)C=C1 MFDFERRIHVXMIY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000004368 propenyl group Chemical group C(=CC)* 0.000 description 1
- 230000000069 prophylactic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 235000010232 propyl p-hydroxybenzoate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- QELSKZZBTMNZEB-UHFFFAOYSA-N propylparaben Chemical class CCCOC(=O)C1=CC=C(O)C=C1 QELSKZZBTMNZEB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000002568 propynyl group Chemical group [*]C#CC([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 238000000159 protein binding assay Methods 0.000 description 1
- 102000004169 proteins and genes Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108090000623 proteins and genes Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 238000000425 proton nuclear magnetic resonance spectrum Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000000746 purification Methods 0.000 description 1
- DVUBDHRTVYLIPA-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyrazolo[1,5-a]pyridine Chemical class C1=CC=CN2N=CC=C21 DVUBDHRTVYLIPA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PBMFSQRYOILNGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyridazine Chemical compound C1=CC=NN=C1 PBMFSQRYOILNGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000003222 pyridines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 125000000714 pyrimidinyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 150000003235 pyrrolidines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000003242 quaternary ammonium salts Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 206010037844 rash Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000011541 reaction mixture Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000007420 reactivation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000011084 recovery Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000001953 recrystallisation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000006268 reductive amination reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002829 reductive effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000010076 replication Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000002345 respiratory system Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 235000019515 salmon Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229920006395 saturated elastomer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 238000007493 shaping process Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000000741 silica gel Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910002027 silica gel Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000000377 silicon dioxide Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000020374 simple syrup Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 210000003491 skin Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 231100000046 skin rash Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 229910000029 sodium carbonate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011780 sodium chloride Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000001509 sodium citrate Substances 0.000 description 1
- NLJMYIDDQXHKNR-UHFFFAOYSA-K sodium citrate Chemical compound O.O.[Na+].[Na+].[Na+].[O-]C(=O)CC(O)(CC([O-])=O)C([O-])=O NLJMYIDDQXHKNR-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 1
- 239000012312 sodium hydride Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910000104 sodium hydride Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 235000019333 sodium laurylsulphate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229940080313 sodium starch Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000012321 sodium triacetoxyborohydride Substances 0.000 description 1
- JJICLMJFIKGAAU-UHFFFAOYSA-M sodium;2-amino-9-(1,3-dihydroxypropan-2-yloxymethyl)purin-6-olate Chemical compound [Na+].NC1=NC([O-])=C2N=CN(COC(CO)CO)C2=N1 JJICLMJFIKGAAU-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 235000010199 sorbic acid Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000004334 sorbic acid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940075582 sorbic acid Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000011069 sorbitan monooleate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000001593 sorbitan monooleate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940035049 sorbitan monooleate Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000007921 spray Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000011150 stannous chloride Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000008107 starch Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940032147 starch Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000019698 starch Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000008117 stearic acid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000010959 steel Substances 0.000 description 1
- 210000000130 stem cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229960005322 streptomycin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 238000007920 subcutaneous administration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000000126 substance Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000005017 substituted alkenyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 125000000547 substituted alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 125000004426 substituted alkynyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 125000003107 substituted aryl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 125000005346 substituted cycloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 238000006467 substitution reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000000758 substrate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000000346 sugar Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000002511 suppository base Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000454 talc Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000012222 talc Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229910052623 talc Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 125000000999 tert-butyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C(*)(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 238000012360 testing method Methods 0.000 description 1
- RAOIDOHSFRTOEL-UHFFFAOYSA-N tetrahydrothiophene Chemical compound C1CCSC1 RAOIDOHSFRTOEL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000003536 tetrazoles Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 230000001225 therapeutic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- VLLMWSRANPNYQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N thiadiazole Chemical compound C1=CSN=N1.C1=CSN=N1 VLLMWSRANPNYQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000002562 thickening agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- XSROQCDVUIHRSI-UHFFFAOYSA-N thietane Chemical compound C1CSC1 XSROQCDVUIHRSI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 208000008732 thymoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229910052718 tin Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- AXZWODMDQAVCJE-UHFFFAOYSA-L tin(II) chloride (anhydrous) Chemical compound [Cl-].[Cl-].[Sn+2] AXZWODMDQAVCJE-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- 238000011200 topical administration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000002054 transplantation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000005208 trialkylammonium group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 150000003852 triazoles Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- QORWJWZARLRLPR-UHFFFAOYSA-H tricalcium bis(phosphate) Chemical compound [Ca+2].[Ca+2].[Ca+2].[O-]P([O-])([O-])=O.[O-]P([O-])([O-])=O QORWJWZARLRLPR-UHFFFAOYSA-H 0.000 description 1
- 230000001960 triggered effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 235000011178 triphosphate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000001226 triphosphate Substances 0.000 description 1
- UNXRWKVEANCORM-UHFFFAOYSA-N triphosphoric acid Chemical compound OP(O)(=O)OP(O)(=O)OP(O)(O)=O UNXRWKVEANCORM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052722 tritium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 230000006433 tumor necrosis factor production Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940108442 valtrex Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 210000004509 vascular smooth muscle cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000003981 vehicle Substances 0.000 description 1
- 210000003462 vein Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 125000000391 vinyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])=C([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 244000052613 viral pathogen Species 0.000 description 1
- 230000008673 vomiting Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000005406 washing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000008215 water for injection Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000080 wetting agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052727 yttrium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- HBOMLICNUCNMMY-XLPZGREQSA-N zidovudine Chemical compound O=C1NC(=O)C(C)=CN1[C@@H]1O[C@H](CO)[C@@H](N=[N+]=[N-])C1 HBOMLICNUCNMMY-XLPZGREQSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960002555 zidovudine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229940107931 zovirax Drugs 0.000 description 1
Classifications
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07D—HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07D471/00—Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00
- C07D471/02—Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00 in which the condensed system contains two hetero rings
- C07D471/04—Ortho-condensed systems
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61P—SPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
- A61P31/00—Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
- A61P31/12—Antivirals
- A61P31/20—Antivirals for DNA viruses
- A61P31/22—Antivirals for DNA viruses for herpes viruses
Definitions
- the present invention relates to novel compounds, pharmaceutical formulations comprising these compounds, and the use of these compounds in therapy. More particularly, the present invention relates to compounds for the prophylaxis and treatment of herpes viral infections.
- herpes group are the sources of the most common viral illnesses in man.
- the group includes herpes simplex virus types 1 and 2 (HSV-1 and HSV-2), varicella zoster virus (VZV), cytomegalovirus (CMV), Epstein-Barr virus (EBV), human herpes virus type 6 (HHV-6), human herpes virus type 7 (HHV-7) and human herpes virus type 8 (HHV-8).
- HSV-1 and HSV-2 are some of the most common infectious agents of man. Most of these viruses are able to persist in the host's neural cells; once infected, individuals are at risk of recurrent clinical manifestations of infection which can be both physically and psychologically distressing.
- Herpes simplex viruses are the causative agents of herpes labialis and genital herpes. HSV infection is often characterised by extensive and debilitating lesions of the skin, mouth and/or genitals. Primary infections may be subclinical although tend to be more severe than infections in individuals previously exposed to the virus. Ocular infection by HSV can lead to keratitis or cataracts thereby endangering the host's sight. Infection in the new-born, in immunocompromised patients or penetration of the infection into the central nervous system can prove fatal. In the US alone, 40 million individuals are infected with HSV-2, a number that is expected to increase to 60 million by 2007.
- VZV Varicella Zoster Virus
- Hupox is the primary disease produced in a host without immunity, and in young children is usually a mild illness characterised by a vesicular rash and fever.
- Shingles or zoster is the recurrent form of the disease which occurs in adults who were previously infected with VZV.
- the clinical manifestations of shingles are characterised by neuralgia and a vesicular skin rash that is unilateral and dermatomal in distribution. Spread of inflammation may lead to paralysis or convulsions. Coma can occur if the meninges become affected.
- VZV is of serious concern in patients receiving immunosuppressive drugs for transplant purposes or for treatment of malignant neoplasia and is a serious complication of AIDS patients due to their impaired immune system.
- CMV infection In common with other herpes viruses, infection with CMV leads to a lifelong association of virus and host. Congenital infection following infection of the mother during pregnancy may give rise to clinical effects such as death or gross disease (microcephaly, hepatosplenomegaly, jaundice, mental retardation), retinitis leading to blindness or, in less severe forms, failure to thrive, and susceptibility to chest and ear infections. CMV infection in patients who are immunocompromised for example as a result of malignancy, treatment with immunosuppressive drugs following transplantation or infection with Human Immunodeficiency Virus, may give rise to retinitis, pneumonitis, gastrointestinal disorders and neurological diseases. CMV infection is also associated with cardiovascular diseases and conditions including restenosis and atherosclerosis.
- EBV infectious mononucleosis
- diseases include lymphoproliferative disease which frequently occurs in persons with congenital or acquired cellular immune deficiency, X-linked lymphoproliferative disease which occurs namely in young boys, EBV-associated B-cell tumours, Hodgkin's disease, nasopharyngeal carcinoma, Burkitt lymphoma, non-Hodgkin's lymphoma, thymomas and oral hairy leukoplakia.
- EBV infections have also been found in association with a variety of epithelial-cell-derived tumours of the upper and lower respiratory tracts including the lung. EBV infection has also been associated with other diseases and conditions including chronic fatigue syndrome, multiple sclerosis and Alzheimer's disease.
- HHV-6 has been shown to be a causative agent of infantum subitum in children and of kidney rejection and interstitial pneumonia in kidney and bone marrow transplant patients, respectively, and may be associated with other diseases such as multiple sclerosis. There is also evidence of repression of stem cell counts in bone marrow transplant patients. HHV-7 is of undetermined disease aetiology.
- Hepatitis B virus is a viral pathogen of world-wide major importance.
- the virus is aetiologically associated with primary hepatocellular carcinoma and is thought to cause 80% of the world's liver cancer.
- Clinical effects of infection with HBV range from headache, fever, malaise, nausea, vomiting, anorexia and abdominal pains.
- Replication of the virus is usually controlled by the immune response, with a course of recovery lasting weeks or months in humans, but infection may be more severe leading to persistent chronic liver disease outlined above.
- W 1 is —(CR 4 R 5 )—(CR 6 R 7 )—, —CR 5 ⁇ CR 7 —, —N ⁇ CR 7 —, —S(O) m — or —O—;
- one of R 1 and R 0 is 4-pyridyl or C 1-4 alkyl-4-pyridyl, provided that when R 1 is C 1-4 alkyl-4-pyridyl the alkyl substituent is located at the 2-position of the pyridine ring, and the other of R 1 and R 0 is
- PCT Publication No. WO 01/14375 to AstraZeneca AB relates to imidazo[1,2-a]pyridine and pyrazolo[2,3-a]pyridine derivatives of formula (I)
- Ring A is a imidazo[1,2-a]pyridine or pyrazolo[2,3-a]pyrid-3-yl; R 2 is as defined therein, m is 0-5; wherein the values of R 2 may be the same or different; R 1 is as defined therein; n is 0 to 2, wherein the values of R 1 may be the same or different; Ring B is phenyl or phenyl fused to a C 5-7 cycloalkyl ring; R 3 is as defined therein; p is 0-4; wherein the values of R 3 may be the same or different; R 4 is as defined therein; q is 0-2; wherein the values of R 4 may be the same or different; and wherein p+q ⁇ 5; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or an in vivo hydrolysable ester thereof.
- the use of the compounds of formula (I) in the inhibition of cell cycle kinases CDK2, CDK4 and CDK6 are also described.
- PCT Publication No. Wo 96/34866 to Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co. Ltd. relates to imidazo[1,2-a]pyridine and imidazo[1,2-a]pyridezine derivatives of formula (I)
- Q is a condensed heterocyclic group having a nitrogen atom in the bridgehead which is unsubstituted or substituted
- X is a hydrogen atom or a group attached through C, O, S or N
- Y is an electron attractive group; or its salt which is useful as an agricultural chemical.
- a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- the pharmaceutical composition may further comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent.
- the pharmaceutical composition further comprises an antiviral agent selected from the group consisting of aciclovir and valaciclovir.
- a method for the prophylaxis or treatment of a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- the herpes viral infection can be any of herpes simplex virus 1, herpes simplex virus 2, cytomegalovirus, Epstein Barr virus, varicella zoster virus, human herpes virus 6, human herpes virus 7, and human herpes virus 8.
- a method for the prophylaxis or treatment of a condition or disease associated with a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- the present invention provides a process for preparing a compound of formula (I) wherein Y is N; R 3 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —C(O)R 7 , —CO 2 R 7 , —SO 2 NHR 9 and —NR 7 R 8 (where R 7 and R 8 are not H); and R 4 is H.
- the process comprises reacting a compound of formula (XI):
- the present invention provides another process for preparing a compound of formula (I), wherein Y is N.
- the process comprises reacting a compound of formula (XIV):
- the present invention provides another process for preparing a compound of formula (I).
- the process comprises reacting a compound of formula (XV):
- the present invention provides a radiolabeled compound of formula (I) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- the present invention provides a tritiated compound of formula (I) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- the present invention provides a biotinylated compound of formula (I) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- the present invention provides a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof for use in therapy.
- the present invention provides a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof for use in the prophylaxis or treatment of a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human.
- the present invention provides a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof for use in the prophylaxis or treatment of a condition or disease associated with a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human.
- the present invention provides the use of a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the prophylaxis or treatment of a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human.
- the present invention provides the use of a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or, prophylaxis of a condition or disease associated with a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human.
- the present invention also provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of formula (I) for use in the prophylaxis or treatment of a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human.
- a compound of the invention or “a compound of formula (I)” means a compound of formula (I) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- a compound of formula (number) means a compound having that formula and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates and physiologically functional derivatives thereof.
- alkyl and alkylene refer to straight or branched hydrocarbon chains containing from 1 to 8 carbon atoms.
- alkyl as used herein include, but are not limited to, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, n-butyl, n-pentyl, isobutyl, isopropyl, and tert-butyl.
- alkylene as used herein include, but are not limited to, methylene, ethylene, propylene, butylene, and isobutylene.
- Alkyl and alkylene also include substituted alkyl and substituted alkylene.
- alkyl groups may be optionally substituted with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of mercapto, nitro, cyano, and halo.
- Perhaloalkyl, such as trifluoromethyl is one particular alkyl group.
- cycloalkyl refers to a non-aromatic carbocyclic ring having from 3 to 8 carbon atoms and no carbon-carbon double bonds. “Cycloalkyl” includes by way of example cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl and cyclooctyl. “Cycloalkyl” also includes substituted cycloalkyl. The cycloalkyl may be optionally substituted on any available carbon(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of mercapto, nitro, cyano, halo and alkyl.
- alkenyl refers to straight or branched hydrocarbon chains containing from 2 to 8 carbon atoms and at least one and up to three carbon-carbon double bonds. Examples of “alkenyl” as used herein include, but are not limited to ethenyl and propenyl. “Alkenyl” also includes substituted alkenyl. The alkenyl groups may optionally be substituted on any available carbon(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of mercapto, nitro, cyano, halo and alkyl.
- cycloalkenyl refers to a non-aromatic carbocyclic ring having from 3 to 8 carbon atoms (unless otherwise specified) and up to 3 carbon-carbon double bonds. “Cycloalkenyl” includes by way of example cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl and cyclohexenyl. “Cycloalkenyl” also includes substituted cycloalkenyl. The cycloalkenyl may optionally be substituted on any available carbon(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of mercapto, nitro, cyano, halo and alkyl.
- alkynyl refers to straight or branched hydrocarbon chains containing from 2 to 8 carbon atoms and at least one and up to three carbon-carbon triple bonds. Examples of “alkynyl” as used herein include, but are not limited to ethynyl and propynyl. “Alkynyl” also includes substituted alkynyl. The alkynyl groups may optionally be substituted on any available carbon(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of mercapto, nitro, cyano, halo and alkyl.
- halo or “halogen” refers to the elements fluorine, chlorine, bromine and iodine.
- Ay refers to monocyclic carbocyclic groups and fused bicyclic carbocyclic groups having from 5 to 12 carbon atoms (unless otherwise specified) and having at least one aromatic ring. Examples of particular aryl groups include but are not limited to phenyl, and naphthyl. “Aryl” also includes substituted aryl.
- Aryl may optionally be substituted on any available carbon with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl (including perhaloalkyl), alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, alkoxy, cycloalkoxy, amino, hydroxy, alkylhydroxy, alkylamine, cycloalkylamine, carboxy, carboxamide, sulfonamide, heterocyclic, heteroaryl, amidine, cyano, nitro and azido.
- Preferred aryl groups according to the invention include but are not limited to substituted and unsubstituted phenyl.
- heterocyclic refers to monocyclic saturated or unsaturated non-aromatic groups and fused bicyclic non-aromatic groups, having the specified number of members and containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms selected from N, O and S.
- heterocyclic groups include but are not limited to tetrahydrofuran, dihydropyran, tetrahydropyran, pyran, oxetane, thietane, 1,4-dioxane, 1,3-dioxane, 1,3-dioxalane, piperidine, piperazine, tetrahydropyrimidine, pyrrolidine, morpholine, thiomorpholine, thiazolidine, oxazolidine, tetrahydrothiopyran, tetrahydrothiophene, and the like.
- Heterocyclic also includes substituted heterocyclic.
- the heterocyclic groups may optionally be substituted on any available carbon(s) or heteroatom(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl (including perhaloalkyl), alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, hydroxy, alkoxy, cycloalkoxy, alkylhydroxy, mercapto, amino, alkylamine, cycloalkylamine, Het, amidine, carboxy, carboxamide, sulfonamide, cyano, nitro and azido.
- Preferred heterocyclic groups according to the invention include but are not limited to substituted and unsubstituted pyrrolidine, piperidine, morpholine, thiomorpholine and piperazine, and substituted variants thereof.
- heteroaryl refers to aromatic monocyclic groups and aromatic fused bicyclic groups having the specified number of members and containing 1, 2, 3, or 4 heteroatoms selected from N, O and S.
- heteroaryl groups include but are not limited to furan, thiophene, pyrrole, imidazole, pyrazole, triazole, tetrazole, thiazole, oxazole, isoxazole, oxadiazole, thiadiazole, isothiazole, pyridine, pyridazine, pyrazine, pyrimidine, quinoline, isoquinoline, benzofuran, benzothiophene, indole, and indazole.
- Heteroaryl also includes substituted heteroaryl.
- the heteroaryl groups may optionally be substituted on any available carbon(s) or heteroatom(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl (including perhaloalkyl), alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, hydroxy, alkoxy, cycloalkoxy, alkylhydroxy, mercapto, amino, alkylamine, cycloalkylamine, Het, amidine, carboxy, carboxamide, sulfonamide, cyano, nitro and azido.
- Preferred heteroaryl groups according to the invention include but are not limited to substituted and unsubstituted pyridine, furan, thiophene, pyrrole, imidazole, pyrazole, and pyrimidine, and substituted variants thereof.
- heterocyclic and heteroaryl groups refers to the total atoms, carbon and heteroatoms N, O and/or S, which form the ring.
- a 6-membered heterocyclic ring is piperidine and an example of a 6-membered heteroaryl ring is pyridine.
- the term “optionally” means that the subsequently described event(s) may or may not occur, and includes both event(s) that occur and events that do not occur.
- the present invention provides compounds of formula (I):
- Y is CH. In another class of compounds of formula (I), Y is N.
- p is 1 or 2. In one embodiment, p is 1. In one embodiment, p is 2. In one embodiment, p is 2 and optionally two adjacent R 1 groups together with the atoms which they are bonded, form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group.
- the phrase “two adjacent R 1 groups” refers to two R 1 groups, each bonded to adjacent carbon atoms on the imidazol-pyridine ring. In the embodiment where two adjacent R 1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a cycloalkyl or heterocyclic group, p is typically 2, 3 or 4; more typically 2.
- R 1 may be in the 5, 6, 7 and/or 8 position. In one embodiment, p is 1 and R 1 is in the C-8 position. In one embodiment, p is 1 and R 1 is in the C-6 position. In one embodiment p is 2 and one R 1 is in the C-8 position and one R 1 is in the C-6 position.
- One class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein at least one R 1 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment, at least one R 1 group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R 1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined where no R 1 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment no R 1 group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeity) and two adjacent R 1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form C 5-6 cycloalkyl or a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein p is 2, no R 1 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment no R 1 group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R 1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group containing 1 or 2 heteroatoms.
- each R 1 is the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of Het, —OHet, —C(O)Het, —NHHet and —R 10 Het, or any subset thereof.
- each R 1 is the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of Ay, Het, —OHet, —C(O)Het, —NR 7 Ay, —NHHet and —R 10 Het, or any subset thereof.
- each R 1 is the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, —OR 7 , —C(O)R 9 , —CO 2 R 9 (or —CO 2 R 10 ), —C(O)NR 7 R 8 , —C(NH)NR 7 R 8 , —S(O) n R 9 , —S(O) 2 NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 R 8 , —R 10 cycloalkyl, —R 10 OR 9 , —R 10 SO 2 NHCOR 9 , —R 10 NR 7 R 8 , cyano, nitro and azido, or any subset thereof.
- each R 1 is the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, —OR 7 , —C(O)R 9 , —CO 2 R 9 (or —CO 2 R 10 ), —C(O)NR 7 R 8 , —C(NH)NR 7 R 8 , —S(O) n R 9 , —S(O) 2 NR 7 R 9 , —NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 Ay, —R 10 cycloalkyl, —R 10 OR 9 , —R 10 SO 2 NHCOR 9 , —R 10 NR 7 R 8 , cyano, nitro and azido, or any subset thereof.
- each R 1 group may be the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of alkyl, —OR 7 , —NR 7 R 8 and —S(O) r R 9 .
- two adjacent R 1 groups are —OR 7 and together with the atoms to which they are bonded, they form a heterocyclic group such as:
- two adjacent R 1 groups are alkyl and together with the atoms to which they are bonded, they form a cycloalkyl group such as:
- two adjacent R 1 groups are defined as —OR 7 and —NR 7 R 8 respectively and together with the atoms to which they are bonded, they form a heterocyclic group such as:
- two R 1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group.
- each R 1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR 7 , —OHet, —C(O)R 9 , —C(O)Het, —CO 2 R 10 , —C(NH)NR 7 R 8 , —S(O) n R 9 , —S(O) 2 NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 Ay, —NHHet, —R 10 cycloalkyl, —R 10 Het, —R 10 OR 9 , —R 10 SO 2 NHCOR 9 , —R 10 NR 7 R 8 , cyano, nitro and azido; or two adjacent R 1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C 5-6 cycloal
- each R 1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —OR 7 , —C(O)R 9 , —C(O)Het, —CO 2 R 9 , —S(O) n R 9 , —S(O) 2 NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 Ay, —NHHet, —R 10 cycloalkyl, —R 10 Het, —R 10 OR 9 , —R 10 NR 7 R 8 , cyano, nitro and azido, or any subset thereof.
- each R 1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Het, —OR 7 , —C(O)Het, —S(O) n R 9 , —S(O) 2 NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 Ay and —NHHet, or any subset thereof.
- each R 1 is the same or different and is independently selected form the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Het, —OR 7 , —S(O) n R 9 , —NR 7 R 8 and —NHHet, or any subset thereof.
- each R 1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, Het, —NR 7 R 8 and NHHet, or any subset thereof.
- R 1 is NR 7 R 8 ; more particularly where R 7 and R 8 are selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl and cycloalkyl.
- each R 1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, —O-alkyl, —S-alkyl, —NH 2 , —NHalkyl, —NHcycloalkyl, —N(alkyl)(alkyl), —N(alkyl)(cycloalkyl), Het, —Nalkyl-O-alkyl, and —NHAy, or any subset thereof.
- R 1 groups are selected from the group consisting of Br, Cl, —O-butyl, —NH 2 , —NH-methyl, —NH-butyl, —N(CH 3 ) 2 , —NH-cyclopentyl, —NH-cyclopropyl, —NH-isopropyl, —NH-phenyl, —N(CH 2 ) 2 OCH 3 , pyrrolidine, and morpholine, or any subset thereof.
- R 7 and R 8 are each the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, —C(O)R 9 , —R 10 -cycloalkyl, —R 10 OR 9 and —R 10 NR 9 R 11 , or any subset thereof. More particularly, R 7 and R 8 are each the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, and —R 10 -cycloalkyl, or any subset thereof. In one embodiment, R 7 and R 8 are each the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl and cycloalkyl, or any subset thereof.
- R 9 and R 11 refers to a PEG-like chain.
- R 9 and R 11 are each the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, and —R 10 -cycloalkyl, or any subset thereof. More particularly, R 9 and R 11 are each the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H and alkyl.
- R 10 is alkyl or cycloalkyl; more particularly alkyl.
- R 2 is H or alkyl, or any subset thereof. In one embodiment, R 2 is H.
- the compounds of formula (I) include those compounds defined where at least one of R 3 and R 4 contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment at least one of R 3 and R 4 contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety but exclude aryl moeities).
- Another embodiment includes those compounds of formula (I) where neither R 3 nor R 4 contain an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or more particularly, neither contain a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeity but may contain an aryl moiety). Based on the guidance given above for R 1 , one skilled in the art can readily determine the list of appropriate groups defining R 3 and R 4 which contain or exclude aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeities.
- R 3 is selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, Ay, —OR 7 , —CO 2 R 7 and —NR 7 R 8 , or any subset thereof. More particularly, R 3 is selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, —OR 7 and —NR 7 R 8 , or any subset thereof. In one particular embodiment R 3 is H or alkyl. In one embodiment R 3 is H.
- R 4 is selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, Ay, —OR 7 , —CO 2 R 7 and —NR 7 R 8 , or any subset thereof. More particularly, R 4 is selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, —OR 7 , and —NR 7 R 8 , or any subset thereof. In one particular embodiment R 4 is H or alkyl. In one embodiment R 4 is H.
- q is 0, 1 or 2. In one embodiment, q is 0. In one particular embodiment, q is 1.
- R 5 may be in the ortho, meta or para position.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein at least one R 5 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment, a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R 5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein q is 3 at least one R 5 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment, a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R 5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined where no R 5 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment no R 5 group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeity) and two adjacent R 5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein q is 2 or 3, no R 5 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment no R 5 group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R 5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- each R 5 group may be the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of alkyl and alkenyl.
- a specific example of a cycloalkyl group formed from two adjacent R 5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded is described above in connection with the description of R 1 groups forming similar groups.
- aryl groups formed from two adjacent R 5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded can be readily determined by those skilled in the art.
- two R 5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- each R 5 group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Ay, Het, —OR 7 , —OAy, —CO 2 R 9 , —C(O)NR 7 R 8 , —S(O) 2 NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 Ay, —NHR 10 Ay, cyano, nitro and azido, or any subset thereof.
- each R 5 group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Het, —OR 7 , —S(O) 2 NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 R 8 , cyano and nitro, or any subset thereof.
- each R 5 group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, —OR 7 , —NR 7 R 5 and cyano, or any subset thereof.
- each R 5 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo (e.g., fluoro, chloro, bromo), alkyl (e.g., methyl and trifluoromethyl), O-alkyl (e.g., O-methyl, O-isobutyl, and
- q′ is 0, 1 or 2. In one embodiment, q′ is 0. In another embodiment, q′ is 1.
- R 5′ may be in the ortho, meta or para position.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein at least one R 5′ group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R 5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein q is 3, at least one R 5′ group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment, a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R 5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined where no R 5′ group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment no R 5′ group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeity) and two adjacent R 5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein q is 2 or 3, no R 5′ group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment no R 5′ group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R 5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- each R 5′ group may be the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of alkyl and alkenyl.
- a specific example of a cycloalkyl formed from two adjacent R 5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded is described above in connection with the description of R 1 groups forming similar rings.
- aryl rings formed from two adjacent R 5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded can be readily determined by those skilled in the art.
- two R 5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C 5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- each R 5′ group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Ay, Het, —OR 7 , —OAy, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —CO 2 R 9 , —C(O)NR 7 R 8 , —S(O) 2 NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 R 8 , cyano, nitro and azido, or any subset thereof.
- each R 5′ group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Het, —OR 7 , —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —C(O)NR 7 R 8 , —S(O) 2 NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 R 8 , cyano and azido, or any subset thereof.
- each R 5′ group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, —OR 7 , —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het and —NR 7 R 8 , or any subset thereof.
- each R 5′ is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo (e.g., fluoro, chloro, bromo), alkyl (e.g., methyl, trifluoromethyl), O-alkyl (e.g., O-methyl, O-isobutyl, and
- Preferred compounds of formula (I) include but are not limited to:
- the compounds of the present invention may also be utilized in the form of a pharmaceutically acceptable salt solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- the pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the compounds of formula (I) include conventional salts formed from pharmaceutically acceptable inorganic or organic acids or bases as well as quaternary ammonium salts.
- suitable acid salts include hydrochloric, hydrobromic, sulfuric, phosphoric, nitric, perchloric, fumaric, acetic, propionic, succinic, glycolic, formic, lactic, maleic, tartaric, citric, palmoic, malonic, hydroxymaleic, phenylacetic, glutamic, benzoic, salicylic, fumaric, toluenesulfonic, methanesulfonic (mesylate), naphthalene-2-sulfonic, benzenesulfonic hydroxynaphthoic, hydroiodic, malic, steroic, tannic and the like.
- the compounds of formula (I) are in the form of the mesylate salt.
- Other acids such as oxalic, while not in themselves pharmaceutically acceptable, may be useful in the preparation of salts useful as intermediates in obtaining the compounds of the invention and their pharmaceutically acceptable salts.
- More specific examples of suitable basic salts include sodium, lithium, potassium, magnesium, aluminium, calcium, zinc, N,N′-dibenzylethylenediamine, chloroprocaine, choline, diethanolamine, ethylenediamine, N-methylglucamine and procaine salts.
- solvate refers to a complex of variable stoichiometry formed by a solute (a compound of formula (I)) and a solvent.
- Solvents include water, methanol, ethanol, or acetic acid.
- physiologically functional derivative refers to any pharmaceutically acceptable derivative of a compound of the present invention, for example, an ester or an amide of a compound of formula (I), which upon administration to an animal, particularly a mammal, such as a human, is capable of providing (directly or indirectly) a compound of the present invention or an active metabolite thereof. See, for example, Burger's Medicinal Chemistry And Drug Discovery, 5th Edition, Vol 1: Principles And Practice.
- Certain compounds of formula (I) and intermediates used in the processes of preparing compounds of formula (I) may exist in stereoisomeric forms (e.g. they may contain one or more asymmetric carbon atoms or may exhibit cis-trans isomerism).
- the individual stereoisomers (enantiomers and diastereomers) and mixtures of these are included within the scope of the present invention.
- the present invention also covers the individual isomers of the compounds represented by formula (I) as mixtures with isomers thereof in which one or more chiral centers are inverted.
- compounds of formula (I) may exist in tautomeric forms other than that shown in the formula and these are also included within the scope of the present invention.
- the present invention further provides compounds of formula (I) for use in medical therapy, e.g. in the treatment or prophylaxis, including suppression of recurrence of symptoms, of a viral disease in an animal, e.g. a mammal such as a human.
- the compounds of formula (I) are especially useful for the treatment or prophylaxis of viral diseases such as herpes viral infections.
- Herpes viral infections include, for example, herpes simplex virus 1 (HSV-1), herpes simplex virus 2 (HSV-2), cytomegalovirus (CMV) (including CMV in organ transplant patients being treated with immunosuppressants), Epstein Barr virus (EBV), varicella zoster virus (VZV), human herpes virus 6 (HHV-6), human herpes virus 7 (HHV-7), and human herpes virus 8 (HHV-8).
- HSV-1 herpes simplex virus 1
- HSV-2 herpes simplex virus 2
- CMV cytomegalovirus
- EBV Epstein Barr virus
- VZV varicella zoster virus
- HHV-6 human herpes virus 6
- HHV-7 human herpes virus 7
- HHV-8 human herpes virus 8
- the compounds of the invention are useful in the treatment or prophylaxis of conditions or diseases associated with herpes virus infections, particularly conditions or diseases associated with latent herpes virus infections in an animal, e.g., a mammal such as a human.
- conditions or diseases associated with herpes viral infections is meant a condition or disease, excluding the viral infection per se, which results from the presence of the viral infection, such as chronic fatigue syndrome which is associated with EBV; and multiple sclerosis which ahs been associated with herpes viral infections such as EBV and HHV-6. Further examples of such conditions or diseases are described in the background section above.
- the compounds of the present invention may also be used for the treatment or prophylaxis of cardiovascular diseases and conditions associated with herpes virus infections, in particular atherosclerosis, coronary artery disease and restenosis and specifically restenosis following angioplasty (RFA).
- Restenosis is the narrowing of the blood vessels which can occur after injury to the vessel wall, for example injury caused by balloon angioplasty or other surgical and/or diagnostic techniques, and is characterized by excessive proliferation of smooth muscle cells in the walls of the blood vessel treated. It is thought that in many patients suffering from restenosis following angioplasty, viral infection, particularly by CMV and/or HHV-6 plays a pivotal role in the proliferation of the smooth muscle cells in the coronary vessel. Restenosis can occur following a number of surgical and/or diagnostic techniques, for example, transplant surgery, vein grafting, coronary by-pass grafting and, most commonly following angioplasty.
- compounds of formula (I) may be useful in the treatment or prophylaxis of hepatitis B or hepatitis C viruses, human papilloma virus (HPV) and HIV.
- the present invention thus provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of a viral infection in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), particularly a herpes viral infection, which method comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- the term “prophylaxis” refers to the prevention of infection, the prevention of occurrence of symptoms in an infected subject, the prevention of recurrence of symptoms in an infected subject, or a decrease in severity or frequency of symptoms of viral infection, condition or disease in the subject.
- the term “treatment” refers to the partial or total elimination of symptoms or decrease in severity of symptoms of viral infection, condition or disease in the subject, or the elimination or decrease of viral presence in the subject.
- the term “therapeutically effective amount” means an amount of a compound of formula (I) which is sufficient, in the subject to which it is administered, to treat or prevent the stated disease, condition or infection.
- a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) for the treatment of a herpes virus infection is an amount sufficient to treat the herpes virus infection in the subject.
- the present invention also provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of conditions or diseases associated with a herpes viral infection in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- the present invention provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of chronic fatigue syndrome and multiple sclerosis in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I).
- the foregoing method is particularly useful for the treatment or prophylaxis of chronic fatigue syndrome and multiple sclerosis associated with latent infection with a herpes virus.
- the present invention provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of a cardiovascular condition such as atherosclerosis, coronary artery disease or restenosis (particularly restenosis following surgery such as angioplasty), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- a cardiovascular condition such as atherosclerosis, coronary artery disease or restenosis (particularly restenosis following surgery such as angioplasty)
- administering comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- the present invention further provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of hepatitis B or hepatitis C viruses in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- a mammal e.g., a human
- the present invention further provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of human papilloma virus in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- a mammal e.g., a human
- the present invention further provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of HIV in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- a mammal e.g., a human
- the present invention also provides the use of the compound of formula (I) in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prophylaxis of a viral infection in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), particularly a herpes viral infection; the use of the compound of formula (I) in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of a condition or disease associated with a herpes viral infection; and the use of the compound of formula (I) in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prophylaxis of hepatitis B or hepatitis C viruses, human papilloma virus and HIV.
- a mammal e.g., a human
- hepatitis B or hepatitis C viruses e.g., hepatitis B or hepatitis C viruses, human papilloma virus and HIV.
- the present invention also provides the use of a compound of formula (I) in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prophylaxis of chronic fatigue syndrome or multiple sclerosis.
- the present invention provides the use of a compound of formula (I) in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prophylaxis of cardiovascular disease, such as restenosis and atherosclerosis.
- compositions are conveniently administered in the form of pharmaceutical compositions.
- Such compositions may conveniently be presented for use in conventional manner in admixture with one or more physiologically acceptable carriers or diluents.
- compositions of the present invention may be therapeutically administered as the raw chemical, it is preferable to present the active ingredient as a pharmaceutical composition.
- the pharmaceutical composition may comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent.
- the carrier(s) or diluent(s) must be “acceptable” in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not deleterious to the recipient thereof.
- the present invention further provides for a pharmaceutical formulation or composition
- a pharmaceutical formulation or composition comprising a compound of formula (I) and optionally also one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers therefore and, optionally, other therapeutic and/or prophylactic ingredients.
- the formulations include those suitable for oral, parenteral (including subcutaneous e.g. by injection or by depot tablet, intradermal, intrathecal, intramuscular e.g. by depot and intravenous), rectal and topical (including dermal, buccal and sublingual) administration although the most suitable route may depend upon for example the condition, age, and disorder of the recipient as well as the viral infection or disease being treated.
- the formulations may conveniently be presented in unit dosage form and may be prepared by any of the methods well known in the art of pharmacy. All methods include the step of bringing into association the compound(s) (“active ingredient”) with the carrier which constitutes one or more accessory ingredients. In the formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association the active ingredient with liquid carriers or finely divided solid carriers or both and then, if necessary, shaping the product into the desired formulation.
- Formulations suitable for oral administration may be presented as discrete units such as capsules (including soft-gel capsules), cachets or tablets (e.g. chewable tablets in particular for paediatric administration) each containing a predetermined amount of the active ingredient; as a powder or granules; as a solution or a suspension in an aqueous liquid or a non-aqueous liquid; or as an oil-in-water liquid emulsion or a water-in-oil liquid emulsion.
- the active ingredient may also be presented as a bolus, electuary or paste.
- a tablet may be made by compression or moulding, optionally with one or more accessory ingredients.
- Compressed tablets may be prepared by compressing in a suitable machine the active ingredient in a free-flowing form such as a powder or granules, optionally mixed with other conventional excipients such as binding agents, (for example, syrup, acacia, gelatin, sorbitol, tragacanth, mucilage of starch or polyvinylpyrrolidone), fillers (for example, lactose, sugar, microcrystalline cellulose, maize-starch, calcium phosphate or sorbitol), lubricants (for example, magnesium stearate, stearic acid, talc, polyethylene glycol or silica), disintegrants (for example, potato starch or sodium starch glycollate) or wetting agents, such as sodium lauryl sulfate.
- binding agents for example, syrup, acacia, gelatin, sorbitol, tragacanth, mucilage
- Moulded tablets may be made by moulding in a suitable machine a mixture of the powdered compound moistened with an inert liquid diluent.
- the tablets may optionally be coated or scored and may be formulated so as to provide slow or controlled release of the active ingredient therein.
- the tablets may be coated according to methods well-known in the art.
- the compounds of the present invention may be incorporated into oral liquid preparations such as aqueous or oily suspensions, solutions, emulsions, syrups or elixirs, for example.
- formulations containing these compounds may be presented as a dry product for constitution with water or other suitable vehicle before use.
- Such liquid preparations may contain conventional additives such as suspending agents such as sorbitol syrup, methyl cellulose, glucose/sugar syrup, gelatin, hydroxyethylcellulose, carboxymethyl cellulose, aluminum stearate gel or hydrogenated edible fats; emulsifying agents such as lecithin, sorbitan mono-oleate or acacia; non-aqueous vehicles (which may include edible oils) such as almond oil, fractionated coconut oil, oily esters, propylene glycol or ethyl alcohol; and preservatives such as methyl or propyl p-hydroxybenzoates or sorbic acid.
- suspending agents such as sorbitol syrup, methyl cellulose, glucose/sugar syrup, gelatin, hydroxyethylcellulose, carboxymethyl cellulose, aluminum stearate gel or hydrogenated edible fats
- emulsifying agents such as lecithin, sorbitan mono-oleate or acacia
- non-aqueous vehicles which may
- Such preparations may also be formulated as suppositories, e.g., containing conventional suppository bases such as cocoa butter or other glycerides.
- Liquid preparations may also be formulated as soft-gel capsules for oral administration, e.g., containing conventional soft-gel excipients such as polyethylene glycol.
- Formulations for parenteral administration include aqueous and non-aqueous sterile injection solutions which may contain anti-oxidants, buffers, bacteriostats and solutes which render the formulation isotonic with the blood of the intended recipient; and aqueous and non-aqueous sterile suspensions which may include suspending agents and thickening agents.
- the formulations may be presented in unit-dose or multi-dose containers, for example sealed ampoules and vials, and may be stored in a freeze-dried (lyophilised) condition requiring only the addition of a sterile liquid carrier, for example, water-for-injection, immediately prior to use.
- a sterile liquid carrier for example, water-for-injection
- Extemporaneous injection solutions and suspensions may be prepared from sterile powders, granules and tablets of the kind previously described.
- Formulations for rectal administration may be presented as a suppository with the usual carriers such as cocoa butter, hard fat or polyethylene glycol.
- Formulations suitable for topical (e.g., dermal) or intranasal application include ointments, creams, lotions, pastes, gels, sprays, aerosols and oils.
- Suitable carriers for such formulations include petroleum jelly, lanolin, polyethyleneglycols, alcohols, and combinations thereof.
- Formulations for topical administration in the mouth include lozenges comprising the active ingredient in a flavoured base such as sucrose and acacia or tragacanth, and pastilles comprising the active ingredient in a base such as gelatin and glycerin or sucrose and acacia.
- a flavoured base such as sucrose and acacia or tragacanth
- pastilles comprising the active ingredient in a base such as gelatin and glycerin or sucrose and acacia.
- the compounds may also be formulated as depot preparations. Such long acting formulations may be administered by implantation (for example subcutaneously or intramuscularly) or by intramuscular injection.
- the compounds may be formulated with suitable polymeric or hydrophobic materials (for example as an emulsion in an acceptable oil) or ion exchange resins, or as sparingly soluble derivatives, for example, as a sparingly soluble salt.
- formulations may include other agents conventional in the art having regard to the type of formulation in question, for example those suitable for oral administration may include flavouring agents.
- a compound of the invention required for use in treatment will vary with the nature of the condition being treated and the age and the condition of the patient and will be ultimately at the discretion of the attendant physician or veterinarian. In general, however, doses employed for adult human treatment will typically be in the range of 0.02-5000 mg per day, typically 100-1500 mg per day.
- the desired dose may conveniently be presented in a single dose or as divided doses administered at appropriate intervals, for example as two, three, four or more sub-doses per day.
- the formulations according to the invention may contain between 0.1-99% of the active ingredient, conveniently from 30-95% for tablets and capsules and 3-50% for liquid preparations.
- the compound of formula (I) for use in the instant invention may be used in combination with other therapeutic agents for example, non-nucleotide reverse transcriptase inhibitors, nucleoside reverse transcriptase inhibitors, protease inhibitors and/or other antiviral agents.
- the invention thus provides in a further aspect the use of a combination comprising a compound of formula (I) with a further therapeutic agent in the treatment of viral infections.
- Particular antiviral agents which may be combined with the compounds of the present invention include aciclovir, valaciclovir, famcyclovir, ganciclovir, docosanoli, miribavir, amprenavir, lamivudine, zidovudine, and abacavir.
- Preferred antiviral agents for combining with the compounds of the present invention include aciclovir and valaciclovir.
- the present invention provides in a further aspect, a combination comprising a compound of formula (I) and an antiviral agent selected from the group consisting of aciclovir or valaciclovir; the use of such combination in the treatment of a viral infection and the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of a viral infection, and a method of treating a viral infection comprising administering a compound of formula (I) and an antiviral agent selected from the group consisting of aciclovir and valaciclovir.
- the compounds of formula (I) When used in combination with other therapeutic agents, the compounds may be administered either sequentially or simultaneously by any convenient route.
- compositions comprising a combination as defined above optionally together with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent comprise a further aspect of the invention.
- the individual components of such combinations may be administered either sequentially or simultaneously in separate or combined pharmaceutical formulations.
- the two compounds When combined in the same formulation it will be appreciated that the two compounds must be stable and compatible with each other and the other components of the formulation and may be formulated for administration. When formulated separately they may be provided in any convenient formulation, in such a manner as are known for such compounds in the art.
- each compound may differ from that when the compound is used alone. Appropriate doses will be readily appreciated by those skilled in the art.
- compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N and R 3 and R 4 are both H can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula (VI) with a compound of formula (VII).
- This method can be readily carried out by mixing a compound of formula (VI) with a compound of formula (VII) in a suitable solvent, optionally in the presence of a base (preferably when the guanidine is in a salt form), and heating the reaction at 20-150° C.
- suitable solvents include lower alcohols such as methanol, ethanol, isopropanol, dimethylformamide, 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone and the like.
- the base is typically a sodium alkoxide, potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine.
- the solvent is 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidone and the base is potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine.
- the compounds of formula (VII) can be prepared according to conventional methods.
- One method for preparing the compounds of formula (VII) involves heating an appropriately substituted aniline with cyanamide in the presence of a protic acid in an alcohol solvent.
- Preferred acids include but are not limited to hydrochloric acid, nitric acid, and sulfuric acid.
- Suitable solvents will be readily apparent to those skilled in the art and include, for example, ethanol.
- the substituted anilines are commercially available or may be prepared using conventional techniques.
- Compounds of formula (VI) may be conveniently prepared by reacting a compound of formula (V) with a dimethylformamide dialkyl acetal of formula (CH 3 ) 2 NCH(ORa) 2 , wherein Ra is alkyl or cycloalkyl.
- Typical dimethylformamide dialkylacetal compounds for use in this method include but are not limited to dimethylformamide dimethylacetal and dimethylformamide di-tert-butylacetal.
- the reaction is carried out by mixing a compound of formula (V) with the dimethylformamide dialkyl acetal, optionally with heating and optionally in the presence of solvent such as N,N-dimethylformamide.
- acylation is carried out by treating the compounds of formula (IV) with an acylating agent, optionally in the presence of an acid or Lewis acid catalyst optionally in an inert solvent with optional heating.
- an acylating agent optionally in the presence of an acid or Lewis acid catalyst optionally in an inert solvent with optional heating.
- Typical acylating agents will be readily determined by those skilled in the art.
- One acylating agent is acetic anhydride.
- Acid catalysts are also known to those skilled in the art.
- One acid catalyst for use in this reaction is sulfuric acid.
- the reaction can also be carried out using N,N-dimethylacetamide and phosphorous oxychloride, optionally in an inert solvent with optional heating.
- Compounds of formula (IV) are conveniently prepared by condensation of aminopyridines of formula (III) with 2-bromoacetophenones of formula (II) optionally in the presence of base.
- the condensation of the aminopyridine of formula (III) with the 2-bromoacetophenone of formula (II) can be accomplished in a suitable solvent at a temperature of about 20-200° C., optionally in the presence of base.
- suitable inert solvents include, but are not limited to, ethanol, isopropanol, N,N-dimethylformamide and the like.
- Suitable bases include sodium bicarbonate, sodium carbonate, potassium carbonate, sodium hydroxide and the like.
- the present invention also provides certain intermediate compounds for use in the preparation of such compounds of formula (I) according to the foregoing process. Such intermediates are described in Scheme 1.
- compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N; R 3 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —C(O)R 7 , —CO 2 R 7 , —SO 2 NHR 9 and —NR 7 R 8 (where R 7 and R 8 are not H); and R 4 is H may be conveniently prepared by the process outlined in Scheme 2 below.
- compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N; R 3 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —C(O)R 7 , —CO 2 R 7 , —SO 2 NHR 9 and —NR 7 R 8 (where R 7 and R 8 are not H); and R 4 is H, may be prepared by reacting a compound of formula (XI) with a compound of formula (VII).
- This method can be readily carried out by mixing a compound of formula (XI) with a compound of formula (VII) in a suitable solvent, optionally in the presence of a base.
- a suitable solvent optionally in the presence of a base.
- the reaction may be heated to 50-150° C. or performed at ambient temperature.
- Typical solvents include but are not limited to lower alcohols such as methanol, ethanol, isopropanol and the like.
- Typical bases include for example, sodium alkoxide, potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine.
- the solvent is N,N-dimethylformamide, 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone and the like and the base is potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine.
- a compound of formula (XI) may be conveniently prepared by oxidation of a compound of formula (X).
- Preferred oxidizing agents include but are not limited to, manganese dioxide, and the like, in an inert solvent.
- Suitable inert solvents include but are not limited to, dichloromethane, chloroform, N,N-dimethylformamide, ether, and the like.
- a compound of formula (X) is oxidized using oxidation methods well known to those skilled in the art of organic chemistry such as Swern oxidation (Omura, K.; Swern, D. Tetrahedron, 1978, 34, 1651) or Dess Martin periodinane oxidation (Dess, D. B.; Martin, J. C. J. Org. Chem., 1983, 48, 4155).
- a compound of formula (X) may be conveniently prepared by reacting a compound of formula (VIII) with a compound of formula (IX).
- Preferred metals (M 1 ) in the compounds of formula (IX) include but are not limited to, lithium, magnesium(II) halides, cerium(III) halides, and the like.
- a compound of formula (IX) may be purchased from commercial sources or prepared by methods known to one skilled in the art.
- a compound of formula (VIII) may be conveniently prepared from a compound of formula (IV) by a formylation procedure.
- the formulation is carried out via the Vilsmeier-Haack reaction.
- the Vilsmeier-Haack reagents can be purchased from commercial sources or prepared in situ. Preferable conditions include, but are not limited to treating compounds of formula (IV) with a premixed solution of phosphorous oxychloride in N,N-dimethylformamide optionally with heating the reaction to 50-150° C.
- the present invention provides certain intermediate compounds for use in the preparation of such compounds of formula (I) according to the foregoing process. Such intermediates are described in Scheme 2 above.
- compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula (XIV) with a compound of formula (VII) followed by oxidative aromatization.
- the condensation is conveniently carried out by treating the compound of formula (XIV) with a compound of formula (VII) in an inert solvent, optionally in the presence of a base.
- the reaction may be heated to 50-150° C. or performed at ambient temperature.
- Suitable inert solvents include lower alcohols such as, for example, methanol, ethanol, isopropanol and the like.
- the base is typically sodium alkoxide, potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine.
- the solvent is N,N-dimethylformamide and the base is potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine.
- the reaction produces a dihydropyrimidine intermediate.
- the dihydropyrimidine intermediate may be oxidized to a compound of formula (I) by the addition of an oxidizing agent.
- the reaction may be heated to 50-150° C. or performed at ambient temperature.
- the oxidizing agent is oxygen (O 2 ), palladium on carbon, 2,3-dichloro-5,6-dicyano-1,4-benzoquinone, or the like.
- a compound of formula (XIV) may be conveniently prepared by oxidation of a compound of formula (XIII).
- Preferred oxidizing agents for the oxidation of compounds of formula (XIII) include but are not limited to manganese dioxide, and the like.
- the oxidation is typically carried out in an inert solvent such as for example, dichloromethane, chloroform, N,N-dimethylformamide, ether, and the like.
- the compound of formula (XIII) is oxidized using oxidation methods well known to those skilled in the art of organic chemistry such as Swern oxidation (Omura, K.; Swern, D. Tetrahedron, 1978, 34, 1651) or Dess Martin periodinane oxidation (Dess, D. B.; Martin, J. C. J. Org. Chem., 1983, 48, 4155).
- a compound of formula (XIII) may be conveniently prepared by reacting a compound of formula (VIII) with a compound of formula (XII).
- a compound of formula (XII) may be purchased from commercial sources or prepared by methods known to one skilled in the art.
- the present invention also provides certain intermediate compounds for use in the preparation of such compounds of formula (I) according to the foregoing process.
- Such intermediates are described above in Scheme 3.
- a compound of formula (I) may be conveniently prepared by the process outlined in Scheme 4 below.
- a compound of formula (I) wherein Y is N or CH can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula (XV) with a compound of formula (XVI).
- the reaction may be carried out in an inert solvent, in the presence of a palladium (0) or nickel (0) catalyst.
- the reaction may optionally be heated to about 50-150° C.
- the reaction is performed by reacting equimolar amounts of a compound of formula (XV) with a Het-metal compound of formula (XVI), but the reaction may also be performed in the presence of an excess of the compound of formula (XVI).
- the palladium or nickel catalyst is typically present in 1-10 mol % compared to the compound of formula (XV).
- Suitable palladium catalysts include but are not limited to, tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium (0), dichlorobis(triphenyl-phosphine)palladium(II), tris(dibenzylideneacetone)dipalladium (0), and bis(diphenylphosphinoferrocene)palladium (II) dichloride.
- Suitable solvents include but are not limited to, N,N-dimethylformamide, toluene, tetrahydrofuran, dioxane, and 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone.
- Het-metal compound of formula (XVI) is an arylboronic acid or ester or an arylborinate the reaction is more conveniently carried out by adding a base in a proportion equivalent to, or greater than, that of the compound of formula (XVI).
- Het-metal compounds of formula (XVI) may be obtained from commercial sources or prepared either as discreet isolated compounds or generated in situ using methods known to one skilled in the art. (Suzuki, A. J. Organomet Chem. 1999, 576, 147; Stille, J. Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. Engl 1986, 25, 508; Snieckus, V. J. Org. Chem. 1995, 60, 292).
- a compound of formula (XV) can be prepared from a compound of formula (IV) by a halogenation procedure.
- the halogenation reaction is carried out by treating a compound of formula (IV) with a halogenating agent in a suitable solvent.
- Suitable halogenating agents include but are not limited to, iodine, N-bromosuccinimide, trialkylammonium tribromides, bromine, N-chlorosuccinimide, N-iodosuccinimide, iodine monochloride, and the like.
- Suitable solvents include, for example, N,N-dimethylformamide, tetrahydrofuran, dioxane, 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone, carbon tetrachloride, toluene, dichloromethane, diethyl ether, and the like.
- the present invention also provides certain intermediate compounds for use in the preparation of such compounds of formula (I). Such intermediates are described in connection with Scheme 4 above.
- Each of the foregoing processes may further comprise the step of converting the compound of formula (I) to a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof, using techniques well known to those skilled in the art.
- a compound of formula (I) may be converted to another compound of formula (I) using techniques well known in the art.
- a compound of formula (I-A), where one R 1 (i.e. denoted Hal) is halogen may be converted to a compound of formula (I-B) using amination techniques known to those skilled in the art.
- Hal is halo, particularly chloro, bromo or iodo
- p′ is p-1
- Amine is a group selected from the group consisting of —NR 7 R 8 , —NR 7 Ay, -Het bonded through N, and —NHHet, and all other variables are as defined in connection with any process above.
- the reaction can be carried out via an adaptation of procedures found in the literature (Wolfe, J. P.; Buchwald, S. L. J. Org. Chem. 2000, 65, 1144) wherein a compound of the formula (I-A) is treated with a suitable amine group, a palladium (0) or nickel (0) source and a base, optionally in a suitable solvent, at temperature ranging from ambient temperature to 200° C.
- Suitable sources of palladium (0) include but are not limited to palladium(II) acetate and tris(dibenzylideneacetone) dipalladium (0).
- Typical bases for use in the reaction include, for example sodium tert-butoxide and cesium carbonate.
- the reaction can be carried out in neat amine or in a suitable solvent. Toluene is an example of a suitable solvent.
- a compound of formula (I-C) (i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R 5 is O-methyl) may be converted to a compound of formula (I-D) (i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R 5 is OH) using conventional demethylation techniques.
- a compound of formula (I-D) may optionally be converted to a compound of formula (I-E) (i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R 5 is OR 10 ).
- the foregoing conversions are represented schematically as follows:
- the demethylation reaction may be carried out by treating a compound of formula (I-C) in a suitable solvent with a Lewis acid at a temperature of ⁇ 78° C. to room temperature, to produce a compound of formula (I-D).
- a Lewis acid at a temperature of ⁇ 78° C. to room temperature
- the solvent is an inert solvent such as dichloromethane, chloroform, acetonitrile, toluene or the like.
- the Lewis acid may be boron tribromide, trimethylsilyl iodide or the like.
- a compound of formula (I-D) may be further converted to a compound of formula (I-E) by an alkylation reaction.
- the alkylation reaction may be carried out by treating a compound of formula (I-D) in suitable solvent with an alkyl halide of formula R 10 -Halo where R 10 is as defined above, to form another compound of formula (I-E).
- the reaction is typically carried out in the presence of a base and with optionally heating to 50-200° C.
- the reaction may be carried out in solvents such as N,N-dimethylformamide, dimethylsulfoxide and the like.
- the base is potassium carbonate, cesium carbonate, sodium hydride or the like.
- the alkylation reaction can be carried out under Mitsunobu conditions.
- a compound of formula (I-F) i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R 5 is halo
- a compound of formula (I-H) i.e. a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R 5 is nitro
- a compound of formula (I-G) i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R 5 is NH 2 ).
- a compound of formula (I-G) may then be converted to a compound of formula (I-I) (i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R 5 is —NR 7 R 8 where R 7 and R 8 are not both H).
- a compound of formula (I-I) i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R 5 is —NR 7 R 8 where R 7 and R 8 are not both H.
- the imine is benzophenoneimine
- the palladium (0) source is tris(dibenzylideneacetone)dipalladium(0)
- the base is sodium tert-butoxide
- the ligand is racemic-2,2′-bis(diphenylphosphino)-1,1′-binaphthyl.
- Suitable solvents include N,N-dimethylformamide and the like.
- a compound of formula (I-G) can also be obtained from a compound of formula (I-H) by reduction.
- the reduction can conveniently be carried out by using zinc, tin or iron and acid, by using tin(II)chloride, or by using palladium or platinum catalysts under hydrogen atmosphere in a suitable solvent as obvious to one skilled in the art of organic synthesis.
- Reaction of a compound of formula (I-G) with compound of formula R 7 -halogen in a suitable solvent in the presence of base, optionally with heating may be used to prepare a compound of formula (I-I).
- base is triethylamine or pyridine and the solvent is N,N-dimethylformamide and the like.
- Additional a compound of formula (I-I) can be obtained by reductive amination of a compound of formula (I-G) with ketones or aldehydes. See, A. Abdel-Magid, et al., J. Org. Chem. 61:3849-3862 (1996).
- a compound of formula (I-G) is treated with an aldehyde or a ketone in the presence of an acid, such as acetic acid, and a reducing agent, such as sodium triacetoxyborohydride or the like, in an inert solvent such as dichloroethane or the like.
- the present invention also provides a radiolabeled compound of formula (I) and a biotinylated compound of formula (I).
- Radiolabeled compounds of formula (I) and biotinylated compounds of formula (I) can be prepared using conventional techniques.
- a radiolabeled compound of formula (I) can be prepared by reacting the compound of formula (I) with tritium gas in the presence of an appropriate catalyst to produce radiolabeled compounds of formula (I).
- the compounds of formula (I) are tritiated.
- the radiolabeled compounds of formula (I) and the biotinylated compounds of formula (I) are useful in assays for the identification of compounds for the treatment or prophylaxis of viral infections such as herpes viral infections. Accordingly, the present invention provides an assay method for identifying compounds which have activity for the treatment or prophylaxis of viral infections such as herpes viral infections, which method comprises the step of specifically binding the radiolabeled compound of formula (I) or the biotinylated compound of formula (I) to the target protein. More specifically, suitable assay methods will include competition binding assays.
- the radiolabeled compounds of formula (I) can be employed in assays according to the methods conventional in the art.
- Analytical thin layer chromatography was used to verify the purity of some intermediates which could not be isolated or which were too unstable for full characterization, and to follow the progress of reactions. Unless otherwise stated, this was done using silica gel (Merck Silica Gel 60 F254). Unless otherwise stated, column chromatography for the purification of some compounds, used Merck Silica gel 60 (230-400 mesh), and the stated solvent system under pressure. All compounds were characterized as their free-base form unless otherwise stated. On occasion the corresponding hydrochloride salts were formed to generate solids where noted.
- 2,3-Dichloropyridine (20 g, 0.14 moles) was placed in a steel bomb. To this was added concentrated ammonium hydroxide (300 mL), the bomb sealed and heated at 190° C. for 48 hours. The vessel was cooled to room temperature and opened. Ethyl acetate and water were added. The phases were separated and the ethyl acetate phase washed with water, dried (magnesium sulfate), filtered and concentrated to a solid. This solid was crystallized from a small volume of ethyl acetate to give 12.6 g (70%) of 2-amino-3-chloropyridine as a white solid.
- 1 H NMR (CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 7.95 (dd, 1H), 7.46 (dd, 1H), 6.58 (q, 1H), 5.0 (broad s, 2H); MS m/z 129 (M+H).
- N,N-Dimethylformamide (30 mL) was cooled to 0° C. and treated with phosphorous oxychloride (1.08 mL, 11.6 mmol). After the addition was complete, the mixture was warmed to room temperature and stirred for 10 minutes. To this was added 8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2- ⁇ ]pyridine (2.0 g, 7.75 mmol) and the resulting solution was stirred for 48 hours. Water was added to the reaction.
- N-(4-fluorophenyl)guanidine nitrate 7.13 g, 37%) as a powder.
- MEM Minimal Essential Media
- FBS Fetal Bovine Serum
- NP40 Fetal Bovine Serum
- Igepal are detergents
- MOI Multiplicity of Infection
- NaOH sodium hydroxide
- MgCl 2 magnesium chloride
- dATP means deoxyadenosine 5′ triphosphate
- dUTP means deoxyuridine 5′ triphosphate
- dCTP means dexoxycytidine 5′ triphosphate
- dGTP means deoxyguanosine 5′ triphosphate
- GuSCN means Guanidinium thiocyanate
- EDTA means ethylenediamine tetraacetic acid
- TE means Tris-EDTA
- SCC sodium chloride/sodium citrate
- APE means a solution of ammonia acetate, ammonia phosphate, EDTA
- PBS means phosphate buffered saline
- HRP HRP
- Cell lysates are prepared as follows: media was removed and replaced with 150 ⁇ L/well 0.2 N NaOH with 1% Igepal CA 630 or NP-40. Plates were incubated up to 14 days at room temperature in a humidified chamber to prevent evaporation.
- a gel-purified, digoxigenin-labeled, 710-bp PCR fragment of the HSV UL-15 sequence was utilized.
- PCR conditions included 0.5 ⁇ M primers, 180 ⁇ M dTTP, 20 ⁇ M dUTP-digoxigenin (Boehringer Mannheim 1558706), 200 ⁇ M each of dATP, dCTP, and dGTP, 1 ⁇ PCR Buffer II (Perkin Elmer), 2.5 mM MgCl 2 , 0.025 units/ ⁇ L of AmpliTaq Gold polymerase (Perkin Elmer), and 5 ng of gel-purified HSV DNA per 100 ⁇ L.
- Extension conditions were 10 min at 95° C., followed by 30 cycles of 95° C.
- the capture DNA plasmid (HSV UL13 region in pUC) was linearized by cutting with Xba I, denatured for 15 min at 95° C. and diluted immediately into Reacti-Bind DNA Coating Solution (Pierce, 17250, diluted 1:1 with TE buffer, pH 8) at 1 ng/ ⁇ L. 75 ⁇ L/well were added to Corning (#3922 or 9690) white 96-well plates and incubated at room temperature for at least 4 hrs before washing twice with 300 ⁇ L/well 0.2 ⁇ SSC/0.050% Tween-20 (SSC/T buffer). The plates were then incubated overnight at room temperature with 150 ⁇ L/well 0.2 N NaOH, 1% IGEPAL and 10 ⁇ g/mL herring sperm DNA.
- the wells were washed 6 ⁇ with 300 mL/well SSC/T buffer then incubated with 75 mL/well anti-digoxigenin-HRP-conjugated antibody (Boehringer Mannheim 1207733, 1:5000 in TE) for 30 min at room temperature.
- the wells were washed 6 ⁇ with 300 ⁇ L/well with PBS/0.05% Tween-20 before 75 mL/well SuperSignal LBA substrate (Pierce) was added.
- the plates were incubated at room temperature for 30 minutes and chemiluminescence was measured in a Wallac Victor reader.
Landscapes
- Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Organic Chemistry (AREA)
- Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
- Virology (AREA)
- General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
- Oncology (AREA)
- Molecular Biology (AREA)
- Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
- Biotechnology (AREA)
- Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
- Communicable Diseases (AREA)
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
- Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
- General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Public Health (AREA)
- Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
- Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
- Nitrogen Condensed Heterocyclic Rings (AREA)
Abstract
Description
- The present invention relates to novel compounds, pharmaceutical formulations comprising these compounds, and the use of these compounds in therapy. More particularly, the present invention relates to compounds for the prophylaxis and treatment of herpes viral infections.
- Of the DNA viruses, those of the herpes group are the sources of the most common viral illnesses in man. The group includes herpes simplex virus types 1 and 2 (HSV-1 and HSV-2), varicella zoster virus (VZV), cytomegalovirus (CMV), Epstein-Barr virus (EBV), human herpes virus type 6 (HHV-6), human herpes virus type 7 (HHV-7) and human herpes virus type 8 (HHV-8). HSV-1 and HSV-2 are some of the most common infectious agents of man. Most of these viruses are able to persist in the host's neural cells; once infected, individuals are at risk of recurrent clinical manifestations of infection which can be both physically and psychologically distressing.
- Herpes simplex viruses (HSV-1 and -2) are the causative agents of herpes labialis and genital herpes. HSV infection is often characterised by extensive and debilitating lesions of the skin, mouth and/or genitals. Primary infections may be subclinical although tend to be more severe than infections in individuals previously exposed to the virus. Ocular infection by HSV can lead to keratitis or cataracts thereby endangering the host's sight. Infection in the new-born, in immunocompromised patients or penetration of the infection into the central nervous system can prove fatal. In the US alone, 40 million individuals are infected with HSV-2, a number that is expected to increase to 60 million by 2007. Over 80% of individuals infected with HSV-2 are unaware they carry and spread the virus, and of those diagnosed less than 20% received oral therapies. The net result is that less than 5% of the infected population are treated. Likewise of the 530 million individuals worldwide who carry the HSV-1 virus, 81% of the symptomatic population remain untreated. No cure exists for HSV infection, and once infected, individuals carry the virus for life in a dormant state. Reactivation of the virus from latency occurs periodically and may be triggered by stress, environmental factors, and/or suppression of the host immune system. Currently, the use of nucleoside analogs such as valaciclovir (V
ALTREX ®) and aciclovir (ZOVIRAX ®) is the standard of care for managing genital herpes virus outbreaks. - Varicella Zoster Virus (VZV) (also known as herpes zoster virus) is a herpes virus which causes chickenpox and shingles. Chickenpox is the primary disease produced in a host without immunity, and in young children is usually a mild illness characterised by a vesicular rash and fever. Shingles or zoster is the recurrent form of the disease which occurs in adults who were previously infected with VZV. The clinical manifestations of shingles are characterised by neuralgia and a vesicular skin rash that is unilateral and dermatomal in distribution. Spread of inflammation may lead to paralysis or convulsions. Coma can occur if the meninges become affected. VZV is of serious concern in patients receiving immunosuppressive drugs for transplant purposes or for treatment of malignant neoplasia and is a serious complication of AIDS patients due to their impaired immune system.
- In common with other herpes viruses, infection with CMV leads to a lifelong association of virus and host. Congenital infection following infection of the mother during pregnancy may give rise to clinical effects such as death or gross disease (microcephaly, hepatosplenomegaly, jaundice, mental retardation), retinitis leading to blindness or, in less severe forms, failure to thrive, and susceptibility to chest and ear infections. CMV infection in patients who are immunocompromised for example as a result of malignancy, treatment with immunosuppressive drugs following transplantation or infection with Human Immunodeficiency Virus, may give rise to retinitis, pneumonitis, gastrointestinal disorders and neurological diseases. CMV infection is also associated with cardiovascular diseases and conditions including restenosis and atherosclerosis.
- The main disease caused by EBV is acute or chronic infectious mononucleosis (glandular fever). Examples of other EBV or EBV associated diseases include lymphoproliferative disease which frequently occurs in persons with congenital or acquired cellular immune deficiency, X-linked lymphoproliferative disease which occurs namely in young boys, EBV-associated B-cell tumours, Hodgkin's disease, nasopharyngeal carcinoma, Burkitt lymphoma, non-Hodgkin's lymphoma, thymomas and oral hairy leukoplakia. EBV infections have also been found in association with a variety of epithelial-cell-derived tumours of the upper and lower respiratory tracts including the lung. EBV infection has also been associated with other diseases and conditions including chronic fatigue syndrome, multiple sclerosis and Alzheimer's disease.
- HHV-6 has been shown to be a causative agent of infantum subitum in children and of kidney rejection and interstitial pneumonia in kidney and bone marrow transplant patients, respectively, and may be associated with other diseases such as multiple sclerosis. There is also evidence of repression of stem cell counts in bone marrow transplant patients. HHV-7 is of undetermined disease aetiology.
- Hepatitis B virus (HBV) is a viral pathogen of world-wide major importance. The virus is aetiologically associated with primary hepatocellular carcinoma and is thought to cause 80% of the world's liver cancer. Clinical effects of infection with HBV range from headache, fever, malaise, nausea, vomiting, anorexia and abdominal pains. Replication of the virus is usually controlled by the immune response, with a course of recovery lasting weeks or months in humans, but infection may be more severe leading to persistent chronic liver disease outlined above.
- PCT Publication No. WO 91/00092 to SmithKline Beecham Corp. refers to imidazo[1,2-a]pyridine compounds of formula (I)
- wherein:
W1 is —(CR4R5)—(CR6R7)—, —CR5═CR7—, —N═CR7—, —S(O)m— or —O—; one of R1 and R0 is 4-pyridyl or C1-4alkyl-4-pyridyl, provided that when R1 is C1-4alkyl-4-pyridyl the alkyl substituent is located at the 2-position of the pyridine ring, and the other of R1 and R0 is -
- (a) phenyl or monosubstituted phenyl wherein said substituent is C1-3alkylthio, C1-3alkylsulfinyl, C2-51-alkenyl-1-thio, C2-51-alkenyl-1-sulfinyl, C3-52-alkenyl-1-thio, C3-52alkenyl-1-sulfinyl, 1-acyloxy-1-alkylthio, C1-2alkoxy, halo, C1-4alkyl or Z wherein Z is —S—S-Z1 and Z1 is phenyl or C1-9alkyl; or
- (b) disubstituted phenyl wherein said substituents are independently C1-3alkylthio, C1-2alkoxy, halo or C1-4alkyl; or
- (c) disubstituted phenyl wherein one of said substituents is C1-3alkylsulfinyl, C2-51-alkenyl-1-thio, C2-51-alkenyl-1-sulfinyl, C3-52-alkenyl-1-thio, C3-52alkenyl-1-sulfinyl, or 1-acyloxy-1-alkylthio and the other is C1-2alkoxy, halo or C1-4alkyl; or
- (d) disubstituted phenyl wherein the substituents are the same and are C1-3alkylsulfinyl, C2-51alkenyl-1-thio, C2-51-alkenyl-1-sulfinyl, C3-52-alkenyl-1-thio, C3-52alkenyl-1-sulfinyl, or 1-acyloxy-1-alkylthio or wherein the substituents together form a methylene dioxy group; or
- (e) monosubstituted phenyl wherein said substituent is
-
- t is 0 or 1; W1, R1, R2, R3, R4, R5, R6, R7, R8 and R9 are as defined herein;
- provided that:
- 1) when W1 is —(CR4R5)—(CR6R7)— then
- n is 0 or 1;
- and R2, R3, R4, R5, R6, R7, R8 and R9 are independently —H or C1-2alkyl; and
- when R1 or R0 is 4-pyridyl, the other of R1 and R0 is other than mono-C1-2alkoxy-substituted phenyl or mono-halo-substituted phenyl; or
- when n is 0, R4 and R5 together are oxo; R4 and R5 are both fluoro, or
- one of R4 and R5 is H and the other is OH;
- 2) when W1 is —CR5═CR7— or —N═CR7— then
- n is 1;
- R3, R5, R7 and R9 are independently —H or C1-2alkyl; and
- R2 and R8 together represent a double bond in the B ring such that the
- B ring is an aromatic pyridine or pyrimidine ring;
- 3) when W1 is —S(O)m— then
- m is 0, 1 or 2;
- n is 1 or 2;
- R3 and R9 are independently —H or C1-2alkyl;
- R2 and R8 are independently —H or C1-2alkyl or R2 and R8 together represent a double bond in the B ring such that the B ring is an aromatic thiazole ring;
- further provided that:
- (a) when R2 and R8 are independently —H or C1-2alkyl and R1 or R0 is 4-pyridyl, then the other of R1 and R0 is other than mono-C1-2alkoxy-substituted phenyl or mono-halo-substituted phenyl; and
- (b) when R2 and R8 together represent a double bond in the B ring such that the B ring is an aromatic thiazole ring, the m is 0 and n is 1; and
- 4) when W1 is —O— then
- n is 1;
- R3 and R9 are independently —H or C1-2alkyl; and
- R2 and R8 together represent a double bond in the B ring such that the
- B ring is an aromatic oxazole ring;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof
for use in the inhibition of interleukin-1 and tumor necrosis factor production by monocytes and/or macrophages.
- PCT Publication No. WO 01/14375 to AstraZeneca AB relates to imidazo[1,2-a]pyridine and pyrazolo[2,3-a]pyridine derivatives of formula (I)
- wherein Ring A is a imidazo[1,2-a]pyridine or pyrazolo[2,3-a]pyrid-3-yl; R2 is as defined therein, m is 0-5; wherein the values of R2 may be the same or different; R1 is as defined therein; n is 0 to 2, wherein the values of R1 may be the same or different; Ring B is phenyl or phenyl fused to a C5-7cycloalkyl ring; R3 is as defined therein; p is 0-4; wherein the values of R3 may be the same or different; R4 is as defined therein; q is 0-2; wherein the values of R4 may be the same or different; and wherein p+q≦5; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or an in vivo hydrolysable ester thereof. The use of the compounds of formula (I) in the inhibition of cell cycle kinases CDK2, CDK4 and CDK6 are also described.
- PCT Publication No. Wo 96/34866 to Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co. Ltd. relates to imidazo[1,2-a]pyridine and imidazo[1,2-a]pyridezine derivatives of formula (I)
- wherein X is vinylene or a group of formula (a):
-
- —NHCO—, —NHSO2—, —OCO—, OCH2—, —NHCOCO—, —NHCOCH═CH—, —NHCOCH2—, —NHCONH or —N(R5)—CO—,
Y is heterocyclic group which may have one or more suitable substituent(s), or aryl which may have one or more suitable substituent(s), Q is CH or N, and I is an integer of 0 or 1, which are the inhibitors of bone resorption and bone metabolism, to processes for preparation thereof, to a pharmaceutical composition comprising the same and to a method for the treatment of disease caused by abnormal bone metabolism in human being or an animal.
- —NHCO—, —NHSO2—, —OCO—, OCH2—, —NHCOCO—, —NHCOCH═CH—, —NHCOCH2—, —NHCONH or —N(R5)—CO—,
- U.S. Pat. No. 5,498,774 and European Patent No. 0 404 190 to Mitsudera et al., relates to condensed heterocyclic compounds of the general formula (I):
- wherein Q is a condensed heterocyclic group having a nitrogen atom in the bridgehead which is unsubstituted or substituted, X is a hydrogen atom or a group attached through C, O, S or N, and Y is an electron attractive group; or its salt which is useful as an agricultural chemical.
- According to a first aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of formula (I):
- wherein:
- p is 0, 1 or 2;
- each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OHet, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7R8, —S(O)R9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido; or
- two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group containing 1 or 2 heteroatoms;
- each R7 and R8 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, —C(O)R9, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR9R11, —SO2R10, —SO2NR9R11, —R10 cycloalkyl, —R10OR9 and —R10NR9R11;
- each R9 and R11 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10OH, —R10(OR10)w where w is 1-10, and —R10NR10R10;
- each R10 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl and alkynyl;
- Ay is aryl;
- Het is a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic or heteroaryl group;
- R2 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl and cycloalkyl;
- n is 0, 1 or 2;
- Y is N or CH;
- R3 and R4 are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —C(O)R7, —CO2R7, —SO2NHR9, —NR7R3, —NHHet and —NHR10Het;
- q and q′ are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of 0, 1, 2 and 3; and
- each R5 and R5′ are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OAy, —OR10Ay, —OHet, —OR10Het, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(O)NR7Ay, —C(O)NHR10Het, —C(S)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7Ay, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7Ay, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay —NHHet, —NHR10Ay, —NHR10Het, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10C(O)R9, —R10CO2R9, —R10C(O)NR9R11, —R10C(O)NR7Ay, —R10C(O)NHR10Het, —R10C(S)NR9R11, —R10C(NH)NR9R11, —R10SO2R9, —R10SO2NR9R11, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, —R10NR7Ay, —R10NHC(NH)NR9R11, cyano, nitro and azido; or
- two adjacent R5 or R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- two adjacent R5 or R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl;
- In another aspect of the invention there is provided a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition may further comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition further comprises an antiviral agent selected from the group consisting of aciclovir and valaciclovir.
- In a third aspect of the invention, there is provided a method for the prophylaxis or treatment of a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human. The method comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof. The herpes viral infection can be any of herpes simplex virus 1, herpes simplex virus 2, cytomegalovirus, Epstein Barr virus, varicella zoster virus, human herpes virus 6, human herpes virus 7, and human herpes virus 8.
- In a fourth aspect, there is provided a method for the prophylaxis or treatment of a condition or disease associated with a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human. The method comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- In another aspect, there is provided a process for preparing a compound of formula (I), wherein Y is N; and R3 and R4 are both H. The process comprises reacting a compound of formula (VI):
-
- wherein p, R1, q, and R5 are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I);
with a compound of formula (VII):
- wherein p, R1, q, and R5 are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I);
-
- wherein R2, q′ and R5′ are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I).
- In another aspect, the present invention provides a process for preparing a compound of formula (I) wherein Y is N; R3 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —C(O)R7, —CO2R7, —SO2NHR9 and —NR7R8 (where R7 and R8 are not H); and R4 is H. The process comprises reacting a compound of formula (XI):
-
- wherein p, R1, q and R5 are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I);
with a compound of formula (VII):
- wherein p, R1, q and R5 are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I);
-
- wherein R2, q′ and R5′ are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I).
- In another aspect, the present invention provides another process for preparing a compound of formula (I), wherein Y is N. The process comprises reacting a compound of formula (XIV):
-
- wherein p, R1, R3, R4, q and R5 are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I);
with a compound of formula (VII)
- wherein p, R1, R3, R4, q and R5 are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I);
-
- wherein R2, q′ and R5′ are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I),
followed by oxidation to prepare the compound of formula (I).
- wherein R2, q′ and R5′ are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I),
- In another aspect, the present invention provides another process for preparing a compound of formula (I). The process comprises reacting a compound of formula (XV):
-
- wherein p, R1, q and R5 are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I) and X1 is halo;
with a compound of formula (XVI):
- wherein p, R1, q and R5 are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I) and X1 is halo;
-
- wherein Y, R2, R3, R4, q′ and R5′ are as defined above in connection with compounds of formula (I) and M2 is selected from the group consisting of —B(OH)2, —B(ORa)2, —B(Ra)2, —Sn(Ra)3, Zn-halide, ZnRa, and Mg-halide where Ra is alkyl or cycloalkyl and halide is halo.
- In another aspect, the present invention provides a radiolabeled compound of formula (I) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof. In one embodiment, the present invention provides a tritiated compound of formula (I) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof. In another aspect, the present invention provides a biotinylated compound of formula (I) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- The present invention provides a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof for use in therapy.
- In yet another aspect, the present invention provides a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof for use in the prophylaxis or treatment of a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human.
- In yet another aspect, the present invention provides a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof for use in the prophylaxis or treatment of a condition or disease associated with a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human.
- In yet another aspect, the present invention provides the use of a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the prophylaxis or treatment of a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human.
- In yet another aspect, the present invention provides the use of a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or, prophylaxis of a condition or disease associated with a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human.
- The present invention also provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of formula (I) for use in the prophylaxis or treatment of a herpes viral infection in an animal, particularly a human.
- As used herein, “a compound of the invention” or “a compound of formula (I)” means a compound of formula (I) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof. Similarly, with respect to isolatable intermediates such as compounds of formula (VI), (XI), (XIV), and (XV), the phrase “a compound of formula (number)” means a compound having that formula and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates and physiologically functional derivatives thereof.
- As used herein, the terms “alkyl” and “alkylene” refer to straight or branched hydrocarbon chains containing from 1 to 8 carbon atoms. Examples of “alkyl” as used herein include, but are not limited to, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, n-butyl, n-pentyl, isobutyl, isopropyl, and tert-butyl. Examples of “alkylene” as used herein include, but are not limited to, methylene, ethylene, propylene, butylene, and isobutylene. “Alkyl” and “alkylene” also include substituted alkyl and substituted alkylene. The alkyl groups may be optionally substituted with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of mercapto, nitro, cyano, and halo. Perhaloalkyl, such as trifluoromethyl is one particular alkyl group.
- As used herein, the term “cycloalkyl” refers to a non-aromatic carbocyclic ring having from 3 to 8 carbon atoms and no carbon-carbon double bonds. “Cycloalkyl” includes by way of example cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl and cyclooctyl. “Cycloalkyl” also includes substituted cycloalkyl. The cycloalkyl may be optionally substituted on any available carbon(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of mercapto, nitro, cyano, halo and alkyl.
- As used herein, the term “alkenyl” refers to straight or branched hydrocarbon chains containing from 2 to 8 carbon atoms and at least one and up to three carbon-carbon double bonds. Examples of “alkenyl” as used herein include, but are not limited to ethenyl and propenyl. “Alkenyl” also includes substituted alkenyl. The alkenyl groups may optionally be substituted on any available carbon(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of mercapto, nitro, cyano, halo and alkyl.
- As used herein, the term “cycloalkenyl” refers to a non-aromatic carbocyclic ring having from 3 to 8 carbon atoms (unless otherwise specified) and up to 3 carbon-carbon double bonds. “Cycloalkenyl” includes by way of example cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl and cyclohexenyl. “Cycloalkenyl” also includes substituted cycloalkenyl. The cycloalkenyl may optionally be substituted on any available carbon(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of mercapto, nitro, cyano, halo and alkyl.
- As used herein, the term “alkynyl” refers to straight or branched hydrocarbon chains containing from 2 to 8 carbon atoms and at least one and up to three carbon-carbon triple bonds. Examples of “alkynyl” as used herein include, but are not limited to ethynyl and propynyl. “Alkynyl” also includes substituted alkynyl. The alkynyl groups may optionally be substituted on any available carbon(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of mercapto, nitro, cyano, halo and alkyl.
- The term “halo” or “halogen” refers to the elements fluorine, chlorine, bromine and iodine.
- The term “Ay” refers to monocyclic carbocyclic groups and fused bicyclic carbocyclic groups having from 5 to 12 carbon atoms (unless otherwise specified) and having at least one aromatic ring. Examples of particular aryl groups include but are not limited to phenyl, and naphthyl. “Aryl” also includes substituted aryl. Aryl may optionally be substituted on any available carbon with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl (including perhaloalkyl), alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, alkoxy, cycloalkoxy, amino, hydroxy, alkylhydroxy, alkylamine, cycloalkylamine, carboxy, carboxamide, sulfonamide, heterocyclic, heteroaryl, amidine, cyano, nitro and azido. Preferred aryl groups according to the invention include but are not limited to substituted and unsubstituted phenyl.
- The term “heterocyclic” (or “heterocycle”) refers to monocyclic saturated or unsaturated non-aromatic groups and fused bicyclic non-aromatic groups, having the specified number of members and containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms selected from N, O and S. Examples of particular heterocyclic groups include but are not limited to tetrahydrofuran, dihydropyran, tetrahydropyran, pyran, oxetane, thietane, 1,4-dioxane, 1,3-dioxane, 1,3-dioxalane, piperidine, piperazine, tetrahydropyrimidine, pyrrolidine, morpholine, thiomorpholine, thiazolidine, oxazolidine, tetrahydrothiopyran, tetrahydrothiophene, and the like. “Heterocyclic” also includes substituted heterocyclic. The heterocyclic groups may optionally be substituted on any available carbon(s) or heteroatom(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl (including perhaloalkyl), alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, hydroxy, alkoxy, cycloalkoxy, alkylhydroxy, mercapto, amino, alkylamine, cycloalkylamine, Het, amidine, carboxy, carboxamide, sulfonamide, cyano, nitro and azido. Preferred heterocyclic groups according to the invention include but are not limited to substituted and unsubstituted pyrrolidine, piperidine, morpholine, thiomorpholine and piperazine, and substituted variants thereof.
- The term “heteroaryl” refers to aromatic monocyclic groups and aromatic fused bicyclic groups having the specified number of members and containing 1, 2, 3, or 4 heteroatoms selected from N, O and S. Examples of particular heteroaryl groups include but are not limited to furan, thiophene, pyrrole, imidazole, pyrazole, triazole, tetrazole, thiazole, oxazole, isoxazole, oxadiazole, thiadiazole, isothiazole, pyridine, pyridazine, pyrazine, pyrimidine, quinoline, isoquinoline, benzofuran, benzothiophene, indole, and indazole. “Heteroaryl” also includes substituted heteroaryl. The heteroaryl groups may optionally be substituted on any available carbon(s) or heteroatom(s) with one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl (including perhaloalkyl), alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, hydroxy, alkoxy, cycloalkoxy, alkylhydroxy, mercapto, amino, alkylamine, cycloalkylamine, Het, amidine, carboxy, carboxamide, sulfonamide, cyano, nitro and azido. Preferred heteroaryl groups according to the invention include but are not limited to substituted and unsubstituted pyridine, furan, thiophene, pyrrole, imidazole, pyrazole, and pyrimidine, and substituted variants thereof.
- The term “members” (and variants thereof e.g., “membered”) in the context of heterocyclic and heteroaryl groups refers to the total atoms, carbon and heteroatoms N, O and/or S, which form the ring. Thus, an example of a 6-membered heterocyclic ring is piperidine and an example of a 6-membered heteroaryl ring is pyridine.
- As used herein, the term “optionally” means that the subsequently described event(s) may or may not occur, and includes both event(s) that occur and events that do not occur.
- The present invention provides compounds of formula (I):
- wherein:
- p is 0, 1 or 2;
- each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OHet, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7R8, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido; or
- two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group containing 1 or 2 heteroatoms;
- each R7 and R8 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, —C(O)R9, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR9R11, —SO2R10, —SO2NR9R11, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10OR9 and —R10NR9R11;
- each R9 and R11 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10OH, —R10(OR10)w where w is 1-10, and —R10NR10R10;
- each R10 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl and alkynyl;
- Ay is aryl;
- Het is a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic or heteroaryl group;
- R2 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl and cycloalkyl;
- n is 0, 1 or 2;
- Y is N or CH;
- R3 and R4 are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —C(O)R7, —CO2R7, —SO2NHR9, —NR7R8, —NHHet and —NHR10Het;
- q and q′ are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of 0, 1, 2 and 3; and
- each R5 and R5′ are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OAy, —OR10Ay, —OHet, —OR10Het, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(O)NR7Ay, —C(O)NHR10Het, —C(S)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7Ay, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7Ay, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —NHR10Ay, —NHR10Het, —R10 cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10C(O)R9, —R10CO2R9, —R10C(O)NR9R11, —R10C(O)NR7Ay, —R10C(O)NHR10Het, —R10C(S)NR9R11, —R10C(NH)NR9R11, —R10SO2R9, —R10SO2NR9R11, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, —R10NR7Ay, —R10NHC(NH)NR9R11, cyano, nitro and azido; or
- two adjacent R5 or R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl;
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates and physiologically functional derivatives thereof.
- two adjacent R5 or R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl;
- In one class of compounds of formula (I), Y is CH. In another class of compounds of formula (I), Y is N.
- In one particular class of compounds of formula (I), p is 1 or 2. In one embodiment, p is 1. In one embodiment, p is 2. In one embodiment, p is 2 and optionally two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms which they are bonded, form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group. The phrase “two adjacent R1 groups” refers to two R1 groups, each bonded to adjacent carbon atoms on the imidazol-pyridine ring. In the embodiment where two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a cycloalkyl or heterocyclic group, p is typically 2, 3 or 4; more typically 2.
- R1 may be in the 5, 6, 7 and/or 8 position. In one embodiment, p is 1 and R1 is in the C-8 position. In one embodiment, p is 1 and R1 is in the C-6 position. In one embodiment p is 2 and one R1 is in the C-8 position and one R1 is in the C-6 position.
- One class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein at least one R1 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment, at least one R1 group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group. Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined where no R1 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment no R1 group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeity) and two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form C5-6 cycloalkyl or a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group. Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein p is 2, no R1 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment no R1 group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group containing 1 or 2 heteroatoms.
- In the embodiment where R1 contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety, each R1 is the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of Het, —OHet, —C(O)Het, —NHHet and —R10Het, or any subset thereof. In the embodiment where R1 contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety, each R1 is the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of Ay, Het, —OHet, —C(O)Het, —NR7Ay, —NHHet and —R10Het, or any subset thereof. In the embodiment where no R1 contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeity, each R1 is the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, —OR7, —C(O)R9, —CO2R9 (or —CO2R10), —C(O)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7R8, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10OR9, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido, or any subset thereof. In the embodiment where no R1 contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeity but may contain an aryl moiety, each R1 is the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, —OR7, —C(O)R9, —CO2R9 (or —CO2R10), —C(O)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7R8, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R9, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —R10 cycloalkyl, —R10OR9, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido, or any subset thereof.
- When two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group having 1 or 2 heteroatoms, p is 2. By “two adjacent R1 groups” is meant that two R1 groups are bonded to adjacent carbon atoms. In such embodiments, each R1 group may be the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of alkyl, —OR7, —NR7R8 and —S(O)rR9. For example, in one embodiment two adjacent R1 groups are —OR7 and together with the atoms to which they are bonded, they form a heterocyclic group such as:
- In another embodiment, two adjacent R1 groups are alkyl and together with the atoms to which they are bonded, they form a cycloalkyl group such as:
- In another embodiment two adjacent R1 groups are defined as —OR7 and —NR7R8 respectively and together with the atoms to which they are bonded, they form a heterocyclic group such as:
- From these examples, additional embodiments can be readily ascertained by those skilled in the art.
- In one embodiment, two R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group.
- In one embodiment (particularly when Y is CH), each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OHet, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Het, —CO2R10, —C(NH)NR7R8, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido; or two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group containing 1 or 2 heteroatoms.
- In one embodiment, each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido, or any subset thereof. More particularly, each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Het, —OR7, —C(O)Het, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay and —NHHet, or any subset thereof. In one embodiment, each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected form the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Het, —OR7, —S(O)nR9, —NR7R8 and —NHHet, or any subset thereof. Particular compounds of formula (I) are defined wherein each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, Het, —NR7R8 and NHHet, or any subset thereof. In another embodiment, R1 is NR7R8; more particularly where R7 and R8 are selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl and cycloalkyl.
- More specifically in one embodiment, each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, —O-alkyl, —S-alkyl, —NH2, —NHalkyl, —NHcycloalkyl, —N(alkyl)(alkyl), —N(alkyl)(cycloalkyl), Het, —Nalkyl-O-alkyl, and —NHAy, or any subset thereof. Specific examples of some particular R1 groups are selected from the group consisting of Br, Cl, —O-butyl, —NH2, —NH-methyl, —NH-butyl, —N(CH3)2, —NH-cyclopentyl, —NH-cyclopropyl, —NH-isopropyl, —NH-phenyl, —N(CH2)2OCH3, pyrrolidine, and morpholine, or any subset thereof.
- In one embodiment, R7 and R8 are each the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, —C(O)R9, —R10-cycloalkyl, —R10OR9 and —R10NR9R11, or any subset thereof. More particularly, R7 and R8 are each the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, and —R10-cycloalkyl, or any subset thereof. In one embodiment, R7 and R8 are each the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl and cycloalkyl, or any subset thereof.
- The group —R10(OR10)w in the definition of R9 and R11 refers to a PEG-like chain. In one embodiment, R9 and R11 are each the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, and —R10-cycloalkyl, or any subset thereof. More particularly, R9 and R11 are each the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H and alkyl.
- In one embodiment R10 is alkyl or cycloalkyl; more particularly alkyl.
- In one embodiment, R2 is H or alkyl, or any subset thereof. In one embodiment, R2 is H.
- In another embodiment, the compounds of formula (I) include those compounds defined where at least one of R3 and R4 contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment at least one of R3 and R4 contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety but exclude aryl moeities). Another embodiment includes those compounds of formula (I) where neither R3 nor R4 contain an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or more particularly, neither contain a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeity but may contain an aryl moiety). Based on the guidance given above for R1, one skilled in the art can readily determine the list of appropriate groups defining R3 and R4 which contain or exclude aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeities.
- In one embodiment, R3 is selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, Ay, —OR7, —CO2R7 and —NR7R8, or any subset thereof. More particularly, R3 is selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, —OR7 and —NR7R8, or any subset thereof. In one particular embodiment R3 is H or alkyl. In one embodiment R3 is H.
- In one embodiment, R4 is selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, Ay, —OR7, —CO2R7 and —NR7R8, or any subset thereof. More particularly, R4 is selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, —OR7, and —NR7R8, or any subset thereof. In one particular embodiment R4 is H or alkyl. In one embodiment R4 is H.
- In one embodiment q is 0, 1 or 2. In one embodiment, q is 0. In one particular embodiment, q is 1.
- R5 may be in the ortho, meta or para position.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein at least one R5 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment, a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl. Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein q is 3 at least one R5 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment, a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl. Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined where no R5 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment no R5 group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeity) and two adjacent R5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl. Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein q is 2 or 3, no R5 group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment no R5 group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- When two adjacent R5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl, q is typically 2 or 3; more particularly 2. By “two adjacent R5 groups” is meant that two R5 groups are bonded to adjacent carbon atoms. In such embodiments, each R5 group may be the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of alkyl and alkenyl. A specific example of a cycloalkyl group formed from two adjacent R5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded is described above in connection with the description of R1 groups forming similar groups. Based on this guidance, examples of aryl groups formed from two adjacent R5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded can be readily determined by those skilled in the art. In one embodiment, two R5 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- In one embodiment, each R5 group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OAy, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHR10Ay, cyano, nitro and azido, or any subset thereof. More particularly, each R5 group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Het, —OR7, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, cyano and nitro, or any subset thereof. In one embodiment, each R5 group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, —OR7, —NR7R5 and cyano, or any subset thereof.
- More specific examples of compounds of formula (I) are defined wherein each R5 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo (e.g., fluoro, chloro, bromo), alkyl (e.g., methyl and trifluoromethyl), O-alkyl (e.g., O-methyl, O-isobutyl, and
- O-allyl, cyano and —NH—(CH2-cyclopropyl), or any subset thereof.
- In one embodiment q′ is 0, 1 or 2. In one embodiment, q′ is 0. In another embodiment, q′ is 1.
- R5′ may be in the ortho, meta or para position.
- Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein at least one R5′ group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl. Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein q is 3, at least one R5′ group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (in one embodiment, a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl. Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined where no R5′ group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment no R5′ group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moeity) and two adjacent R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl. Another class of compounds of formula (I) includes those compounds defined wherein q is 2 or 3, no R5′ group contains an aryl, heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety (or in one embodiment no R5′ group contains a heterocyclic or heteroaryl moiety) and two adjacent R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- When two adjacent R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl, q is typically 2 or 3; more typically 2. By “two adjacent R5′ groups” is meant that two R5′ groups are bonded to adjacent carbon atoms. In such embodiments, each R5′ group may be the same or different and is typically selected from the group consisting of alkyl and alkenyl. A specific example of a cycloalkyl formed from two adjacent R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded is described above in connection with the description of R1 groups forming similar rings. Based on this guidance, aryl rings formed from two adjacent R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded can be readily determined by those skilled in the art. In one embodiment, two R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded do not form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl.
- In one embodiment, each R5′ group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OAy, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido, or any subset thereof. More particularly, each R5′ group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Het, —OR7, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —C(O)NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, cyano and azido, or any subset thereof. In one embodiment, each R5′ group is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, —OR7, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het and —NR7R8, or any subset thereof.
- More specific examples of compounds of formula (I) are defined wherein each R5′ is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo (e.g., fluoro, chloro, bromo), alkyl (e.g., methyl, trifluoromethyl), O-alkyl (e.g., O-methyl, O-isobutyl, and
- O-allyl, —NH—CH3 and —N(CH3)2, or any subset thereof.
- It is to be understood that the present invention includes all combinations and subsets of the particular and specific groups defined hereinabove.
- Preferred compounds of formula (I) include but are not limited to:
- 4-[8-Chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-N-phenylpyrimidin-2-amine;
- N-Cyclopentyl-3-[2-(cyclopentylamino)-4-pyrimidinyl]-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo-[1,2-α]pyridin-8-amine;
- 4-[8-Chloro-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-N-phenylpyrimidin-2-amine;
- 3-(2-Anilino-4-pyrimidinyl)-N-cyclopentyl-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-8-amine; and
- 4-[8-Chloro-2-(3-nitrophenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-N-(4-fluorophenyl)pyrimidin-2-amine;
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates and physiologically functional derivatives thereof. - It will be appreciated by those skilled in the art that the compounds of the present invention may also be utilized in the form of a pharmaceutically acceptable salt solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof. The pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the compounds of formula (I) include conventional salts formed from pharmaceutically acceptable inorganic or organic acids or bases as well as quaternary ammonium salts. More specific examples of suitable acid salts include hydrochloric, hydrobromic, sulfuric, phosphoric, nitric, perchloric, fumaric, acetic, propionic, succinic, glycolic, formic, lactic, maleic, tartaric, citric, palmoic, malonic, hydroxymaleic, phenylacetic, glutamic, benzoic, salicylic, fumaric, toluenesulfonic, methanesulfonic (mesylate), naphthalene-2-sulfonic, benzenesulfonic hydroxynaphthoic, hydroiodic, malic, steroic, tannic and the like. In one embodiment, the compounds of formula (I) are in the form of the mesylate salt. Other acids such as oxalic, while not in themselves pharmaceutically acceptable, may be useful in the preparation of salts useful as intermediates in obtaining the compounds of the invention and their pharmaceutically acceptable salts. More specific examples of suitable basic salts include sodium, lithium, potassium, magnesium, aluminium, calcium, zinc, N,N′-dibenzylethylenediamine, chloroprocaine, choline, diethanolamine, ethylenediamine, N-methylglucamine and procaine salts.
- The term “solvate” as used herein refers to a complex of variable stoichiometry formed by a solute (a compound of formula (I)) and a solvent. Solvents, by way of example, include water, methanol, ethanol, or acetic acid.
- The term “physiologically functional derivative” as used herein refers to any pharmaceutically acceptable derivative of a compound of the present invention, for example, an ester or an amide of a compound of formula (I), which upon administration to an animal, particularly a mammal, such as a human, is capable of providing (directly or indirectly) a compound of the present invention or an active metabolite thereof. See, for example, Burger's Medicinal Chemistry And Drug Discovery, 5th Edition, Vol 1: Principles And Practice.
- Processes for preparing pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates and physiologically functional derivatives of the compound of formula (I) are conventional in the art. See, for example, Burger's Medicinal Chemistry And Drug Discovery, 5th Edition, Vol 1: Principles And Practice.
- As will be apparent to those skilled in the art, in the processes described below for the preparation of compounds of formula (I), certain intermediates, including but not limited to compounds of formulas (VI, XI, XIV and XV), may be in the form of pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates or physiologically functional derivatives of the compound. Those terms as applied to any intermediate employed in the process of preparing compounds of formula (I) have the same meanings as noted above with respect to compounds of formula (I). Processes for preparing pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates and physiologically functional derivatives of such intermediates are known in the art and are analogous to the process for preparing pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates and physiologically functional derivatives of the compounds of formula (I).
- Certain compounds of formula (I) and intermediates used in the processes of preparing compounds of formula (I) may exist in stereoisomeric forms (e.g. they may contain one or more asymmetric carbon atoms or may exhibit cis-trans isomerism). The individual stereoisomers (enantiomers and diastereomers) and mixtures of these are included within the scope of the present invention. The present invention also covers the individual isomers of the compounds represented by formula (I) as mixtures with isomers thereof in which one or more chiral centers are inverted. Likewise, it is understood that compounds of formula (I) may exist in tautomeric forms other than that shown in the formula and these are also included within the scope of the present invention.
- The present invention further provides compounds of formula (I) for use in medical therapy, e.g. in the treatment or prophylaxis, including suppression of recurrence of symptoms, of a viral disease in an animal, e.g. a mammal such as a human. The compounds of formula (I) are especially useful for the treatment or prophylaxis of viral diseases such as herpes viral infections. Herpes viral infections include, for example, herpes simplex virus 1 (HSV-1), herpes simplex virus 2 (HSV-2), cytomegalovirus (CMV) (including CMV in organ transplant patients being treated with immunosuppressants), Epstein Barr virus (EBV), varicella zoster virus (VZV), human herpes virus 6 (HHV-6), human herpes virus 7 (HHV-7), and human herpes virus 8 (HHV-8). Thus, the compounds of the invention are also useful in the treatment or prophylaxis of the symptoms or effects of herpes virus infections.
- The compounds of the invention are useful in the treatment or prophylaxis of conditions or diseases associated with herpes virus infections, particularly conditions or diseases associated with latent herpes virus infections in an animal, e.g., a mammal such as a human. By conditions or diseases associated with herpes viral infections is meant a condition or disease, excluding the viral infection per se, which results from the presence of the viral infection, such as chronic fatigue syndrome which is associated with EBV; and multiple sclerosis which ahs been associated with herpes viral infections such as EBV and HHV-6. Further examples of such conditions or diseases are described in the background section above.
- In addition to those conditions and diseases, the compounds of the present invention may also be used for the treatment or prophylaxis of cardiovascular diseases and conditions associated with herpes virus infections, in particular atherosclerosis, coronary artery disease and restenosis and specifically restenosis following angioplasty (RFA). Restenosis is the narrowing of the blood vessels which can occur after injury to the vessel wall, for example injury caused by balloon angioplasty or other surgical and/or diagnostic techniques, and is characterized by excessive proliferation of smooth muscle cells in the walls of the blood vessel treated. It is thought that in many patients suffering from restenosis following angioplasty, viral infection, particularly by CMV and/or HHV-6 plays a pivotal role in the proliferation of the smooth muscle cells in the coronary vessel. Restenosis can occur following a number of surgical and/or diagnostic techniques, for example, transplant surgery, vein grafting, coronary by-pass grafting and, most commonly following angioplasty.
- There is evidence from work done both in vitro and in vivo, indicating that restenosis is a multifactorial process. Several cytokines and growth factors, acting in concert, stimulate the migration and proliferation of vascular smooth muscle cells (SMC) and production of extracellular matrix material, which accumulate to occlude the blood vessel. In addition growth suppressors act to inhibit the proliferation of SMC's and production of extracellular matrix material.
- In addition, compounds of formula (I) may be useful in the treatment or prophylaxis of hepatitis B or hepatitis C viruses, human papilloma virus (HPV) and HIV.
- The present invention thus provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of a viral infection in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), particularly a herpes viral infection, which method comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- As used herein, the term “prophylaxis” refers to the prevention of infection, the prevention of occurrence of symptoms in an infected subject, the prevention of recurrence of symptoms in an infected subject, or a decrease in severity or frequency of symptoms of viral infection, condition or disease in the subject.
- As used herein, the term “treatment” refers to the partial or total elimination of symptoms or decrease in severity of symptoms of viral infection, condition or disease in the subject, or the elimination or decrease of viral presence in the subject. As used herein, the term “therapeutically effective amount” means an amount of a compound of formula (I) which is sufficient, in the subject to which it is administered, to treat or prevent the stated disease, condition or infection. For example, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) for the treatment of a herpes virus infection is an amount sufficient to treat the herpes virus infection in the subject.
- The present invention also provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of conditions or diseases associated with a herpes viral infection in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I). In one embodiment, the present invention provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of chronic fatigue syndrome and multiple sclerosis in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I). The foregoing method is particularly useful for the treatment or prophylaxis of chronic fatigue syndrome and multiple sclerosis associated with latent infection with a herpes virus.
- In another embodiment, the present invention provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of a cardiovascular condition such as atherosclerosis, coronary artery disease or restenosis (particularly restenosis following surgery such as angioplasty), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- The present invention further provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of hepatitis B or hepatitis C viruses in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- The present invention further provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of human papilloma virus in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- The present invention further provides a method for the treatment or prophylaxis of HIV in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), which comprises administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I).
- The present invention also provides the use of the compound of formula (I) in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prophylaxis of a viral infection in an animal such as a mammal (e.g., a human), particularly a herpes viral infection; the use of the compound of formula (I) in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of a condition or disease associated with a herpes viral infection; and the use of the compound of formula (I) in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prophylaxis of hepatitis B or hepatitis C viruses, human papilloma virus and HIV. In particular, the present invention also provides the use of a compound of formula (I) in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prophylaxis of chronic fatigue syndrome or multiple sclerosis. In one embodiment, the present invention provides the use of a compound of formula (I) in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prophylaxis of cardiovascular disease, such as restenosis and atherosclerosis.
- The compounds of formula (I) are conveniently administered in the form of pharmaceutical compositions. Such compositions may conveniently be presented for use in conventional manner in admixture with one or more physiologically acceptable carriers or diluents.
- While it is possible that compounds of the present invention may be therapeutically administered as the raw chemical, it is preferable to present the active ingredient as a pharmaceutical composition. The pharmaceutical composition may comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent. The carrier(s) or diluent(s) must be “acceptable” in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not deleterious to the recipient thereof.
- Accordingly, the present invention further provides for a pharmaceutical formulation or composition comprising a compound of formula (I) and optionally also one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers therefore and, optionally, other therapeutic and/or prophylactic ingredients.
- The formulations include those suitable for oral, parenteral (including subcutaneous e.g. by injection or by depot tablet, intradermal, intrathecal, intramuscular e.g. by depot and intravenous), rectal and topical (including dermal, buccal and sublingual) administration although the most suitable route may depend upon for example the condition, age, and disorder of the recipient as well as the viral infection or disease being treated. The formulations may conveniently be presented in unit dosage form and may be prepared by any of the methods well known in the art of pharmacy. All methods include the step of bringing into association the compound(s) (“active ingredient”) with the carrier which constitutes one or more accessory ingredients. In the formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association the active ingredient with liquid carriers or finely divided solid carriers or both and then, if necessary, shaping the product into the desired formulation.
- Formulations suitable for oral administration may be presented as discrete units such as capsules (including soft-gel capsules), cachets or tablets (e.g. chewable tablets in particular for paediatric administration) each containing a predetermined amount of the active ingredient; as a powder or granules; as a solution or a suspension in an aqueous liquid or a non-aqueous liquid; or as an oil-in-water liquid emulsion or a water-in-oil liquid emulsion. The active ingredient may also be presented as a bolus, electuary or paste.
- A tablet may be made by compression or moulding, optionally with one or more accessory ingredients. Compressed tablets may be prepared by compressing in a suitable machine the active ingredient in a free-flowing form such as a powder or granules, optionally mixed with other conventional excipients such as binding agents, (for example, syrup, acacia, gelatin, sorbitol, tragacanth, mucilage of starch or polyvinylpyrrolidone), fillers (for example, lactose, sugar, microcrystalline cellulose, maize-starch, calcium phosphate or sorbitol), lubricants (for example, magnesium stearate, stearic acid, talc, polyethylene glycol or silica), disintegrants (for example, potato starch or sodium starch glycollate) or wetting agents, such as sodium lauryl sulfate. Moulded tablets may be made by moulding in a suitable machine a mixture of the powdered compound moistened with an inert liquid diluent. The tablets may optionally be coated or scored and may be formulated so as to provide slow or controlled release of the active ingredient therein. The tablets may be coated according to methods well-known in the art.
- Alternatively, the compounds of the present invention may be incorporated into oral liquid preparations such as aqueous or oily suspensions, solutions, emulsions, syrups or elixirs, for example. Moreover, formulations containing these compounds may be presented as a dry product for constitution with water or other suitable vehicle before use. Such liquid preparations may contain conventional additives such as suspending agents such as sorbitol syrup, methyl cellulose, glucose/sugar syrup, gelatin, hydroxyethylcellulose, carboxymethyl cellulose, aluminum stearate gel or hydrogenated edible fats; emulsifying agents such as lecithin, sorbitan mono-oleate or acacia; non-aqueous vehicles (which may include edible oils) such as almond oil, fractionated coconut oil, oily esters, propylene glycol or ethyl alcohol; and preservatives such as methyl or propyl p-hydroxybenzoates or sorbic acid. Such preparations may also be formulated as suppositories, e.g., containing conventional suppository bases such as cocoa butter or other glycerides. Liquid preparations may also be formulated as soft-gel capsules for oral administration, e.g., containing conventional soft-gel excipients such as polyethylene glycol.
- Formulations for parenteral administration include aqueous and non-aqueous sterile injection solutions which may contain anti-oxidants, buffers, bacteriostats and solutes which render the formulation isotonic with the blood of the intended recipient; and aqueous and non-aqueous sterile suspensions which may include suspending agents and thickening agents.
- The formulations may be presented in unit-dose or multi-dose containers, for example sealed ampoules and vials, and may be stored in a freeze-dried (lyophilised) condition requiring only the addition of a sterile liquid carrier, for example, water-for-injection, immediately prior to use. Extemporaneous injection solutions and suspensions may be prepared from sterile powders, granules and tablets of the kind previously described.
- Formulations for rectal administration may be presented as a suppository with the usual carriers such as cocoa butter, hard fat or polyethylene glycol.
- Formulations suitable for topical (e.g., dermal) or intranasal application include ointments, creams, lotions, pastes, gels, sprays, aerosols and oils. Suitable carriers for such formulations include petroleum jelly, lanolin, polyethyleneglycols, alcohols, and combinations thereof.
- Formulations for topical administration in the mouth, for example buccally or sublingually, include lozenges comprising the active ingredient in a flavoured base such as sucrose and acacia or tragacanth, and pastilles comprising the active ingredient in a base such as gelatin and glycerin or sucrose and acacia.
- The compounds may also be formulated as depot preparations. Such long acting formulations may be administered by implantation (for example subcutaneously or intramuscularly) or by intramuscular injection. Thus, for example, the compounds may be formulated with suitable polymeric or hydrophobic materials (for example as an emulsion in an acceptable oil) or ion exchange resins, or as sparingly soluble derivatives, for example, as a sparingly soluble salt.
- In addition to the ingredients particularly mentioned above, the formulations may include other agents conventional in the art having regard to the type of formulation in question, for example those suitable for oral administration may include flavouring agents.
- It will be appreciated that the amount of a compound of the invention required for use in treatment will vary with the nature of the condition being treated and the age and the condition of the patient and will be ultimately at the discretion of the attendant physician or veterinarian. In general, however, doses employed for adult human treatment will typically be in the range of 0.02-5000 mg per day, typically 100-1500 mg per day. The desired dose may conveniently be presented in a single dose or as divided doses administered at appropriate intervals, for example as two, three, four or more sub-doses per day. The formulations according to the invention may contain between 0.1-99% of the active ingredient, conveniently from 30-95% for tablets and capsules and 3-50% for liquid preparations.
- The compound of formula (I) for use in the instant invention may be used in combination with other therapeutic agents for example, non-nucleotide reverse transcriptase inhibitors, nucleoside reverse transcriptase inhibitors, protease inhibitors and/or other antiviral agents. The invention thus provides in a further aspect the use of a combination comprising a compound of formula (I) with a further therapeutic agent in the treatment of viral infections. Particular antiviral agents which may be combined with the compounds of the present invention include aciclovir, valaciclovir, famcyclovir, ganciclovir, docosanoli, miribavir, amprenavir, lamivudine, zidovudine, and abacavir. Preferred antiviral agents for combining with the compounds of the present invention include aciclovir and valaciclovir. Thus the present invention provides in a further aspect, a combination comprising a compound of formula (I) and an antiviral agent selected from the group consisting of aciclovir or valaciclovir; the use of such combination in the treatment of a viral infection and the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of a viral infection, and a method of treating a viral infection comprising administering a compound of formula (I) and an antiviral agent selected from the group consisting of aciclovir and valaciclovir.
- When the compounds of formula (I) are used in combination with other therapeutic agents, the compounds may be administered either sequentially or simultaneously by any convenient route.
- The combinations referred to above may conveniently be presented for use in the form of a pharmaceutical formulation and thus pharmaceutical formulations comprising a combination as defined above optionally together with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent comprise a further aspect of the invention. The individual components of such combinations may be administered either sequentially or simultaneously in separate or combined pharmaceutical formulations.
- When combined in the same formulation it will be appreciated that the two compounds must be stable and compatible with each other and the other components of the formulation and may be formulated for administration. When formulated separately they may be provided in any convenient formulation, in such a manner as are known for such compounds in the art.
- When a compound of formula (I) is used in combination with a second therapeutic agent active against the viral infection, the dose of each compound may differ from that when the compound is used alone. Appropriate doses will be readily appreciated by those skilled in the art.
- Compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N; and R3 and R4 are both H, may be conveniently prepared by a general process outlined in Scheme 1 below.
- wherein:
- p is 0, 1 or 2;
- each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OHet, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7R8, —S(O)R9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido; or two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group containing 1 or 2 heteroatoms;
- each R7 and R8 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, —C(O)R9, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR9R11, —SO2R10, —SO2NR9R11, —R10 cycloalkyl, —R10OR9 and —R10NR9R11;
- each R9 and R11 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, —R10 cycloalkyl, —R10OH, —R10(OR10)w where w is 1-10, and —R10NR10R10;
- each R10 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl and alkynyl;
- Ay is aryl;
- Het is a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic or heteroaryl group;
- R2 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl and cycloalkyl;
- n is 0, 1 or 2;
- Y is N;
- R3 and R4 are both H;
- q and q′ are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of 0,1, 2 and 3;
- each R5 and R5′ are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OAy, —OR10Ay, —OHet, —OR10Het, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(O)NR7Ay, —C(O)NHR10Het, —C(S)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7Ay, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7Ay, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —NHR10Ay, —NHR10Het, —R10 cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10C(O)R9, —R10CO2R9, —R10C(O)NR9R11, —R10C(O)NR7Ay, —R10C(O)NHR10Het, —R10C(S)NR9R11, —R10C(NH)NR9R11, —R10SO2R9, —R10 SO2NR9R11, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, —R10NR7Ay, —R10NHC(NH)NR9R11, cyano, nitro and azido; or two adjacent R5 or R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl; and
- Ra is alkyl or cycloalkyl.
- Generally, the process for preparing the compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N and R3 and R4 are both H, (all formulas and all other variables having been defined above in connection with Scheme 1) comprises the steps of:
- (a) reacting an aminopyridine of formula (III) with a 2-bromoacetophenone of formula (II) to prepare a compound of formula (IV);
(b) acylating the compound of formula (IV) to prepare a compound of formula (V);
(c) reacting the compound of formula (V) with a dimethylformamide dialkyl acetal of formula (CH3)2NCH(ORa)2 to prepare a compound of formula (VI); and
(d) reacting the compound of formula (VI) with a compound of formula (VII) to prepare a compound of formula (I). - More specifically, compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N and R3 and R4 are both H, can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula (VI) with a compound of formula (VII).
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 1.
- This method can be readily carried out by mixing a compound of formula (VI) with a compound of formula (VII) in a suitable solvent, optionally in the presence of a base (preferably when the guanidine is in a salt form), and heating the reaction at 20-150° C. Typical solvents include lower alcohols such as methanol, ethanol, isopropanol, dimethylformamide, 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone and the like. The base is typically a sodium alkoxide, potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine. In one embodiment, the solvent is 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidone and the base is potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine.
- The compounds of formula (VII) can be prepared according to conventional methods. One method for preparing the compounds of formula (VII) involves heating an appropriately substituted aniline with cyanamide in the presence of a protic acid in an alcohol solvent.
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 1.
- This method is adapted from the procedures described in WO 00/78731 published 28 Dec. 2000, the subject matter of which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety. Preferred acids include but are not limited to hydrochloric acid, nitric acid, and sulfuric acid. Suitable solvents will be readily apparent to those skilled in the art and include, for example, ethanol.
- The substituted anilines are commercially available or may be prepared using conventional techniques.
- Compounds of formula (VI) may be conveniently prepared by reacting a compound of formula (V) with a dimethylformamide dialkyl acetal of formula (CH3)2NCH(ORa)2, wherein Ra is alkyl or cycloalkyl.
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 1.
- Typical dimethylformamide dialkylacetal compounds for use in this method include but are not limited to dimethylformamide dimethylacetal and dimethylformamide di-tert-butylacetal. The reaction is carried out by mixing a compound of formula (V) with the dimethylformamide dialkyl acetal, optionally with heating and optionally in the presence of solvent such as N,N-dimethylformamide.
- Compounds of formula (V) may be conveniently prepared from compounds of formula (IV) using an acylation procedure.
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 1.
- Typically the acylation is carried out by treating the compounds of formula (IV) with an acylating agent, optionally in the presence of an acid or Lewis acid catalyst optionally in an inert solvent with optional heating. Typical acylating agents will be readily determined by those skilled in the art. One acylating agent is acetic anhydride. Acid catalysts are also known to those skilled in the art. One acid catalyst for use in this reaction is sulfuric acid.
- The reaction can also be carried out using N,N-dimethylacetamide and phosphorous oxychloride, optionally in an inert solvent with optional heating.
- Compounds of formula (IV) are conveniently prepared by condensation of aminopyridines of formula (III) with 2-bromoacetophenones of formula (II) optionally in the presence of base.
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 1.
- The condensation of the aminopyridine of formula (III) with the 2-bromoacetophenone of formula (II) can be accomplished in a suitable solvent at a temperature of about 20-200° C., optionally in the presence of base. Suitable inert solvents include, but are not limited to, ethanol, isopropanol, N,N-dimethylformamide and the like. Suitable bases include sodium bicarbonate, sodium carbonate, potassium carbonate, sodium hydroxide and the like.
- Compounds of formula (II) and (III) are commercially available or may be prepared using methods known to those skilled in the art.
- In addition to the foregoing process for preparing certain compounds of formula (I), the present invention also provides certain intermediate compounds for use in the preparation of such compounds of formula (I) according to the foregoing process. Such intermediates are described in Scheme 1.
- In a further embodiment of the present invention, compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N; R3 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —C(O)R7, —CO2R7, —SO2NHR9 and —NR7R8 (where R7 and R8 are not H); and R4 is H, may be conveniently prepared by the process outlined in Scheme 2 below.
- wherein:
- p is 0, 1 or 2;
- each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OHet, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7R8, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R3, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido; or
- two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group containing 1 or 2 heteroatoms;
- each R7 and R8 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, —C(O)R9, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR9R11, —SO2R10, —SO2NR9R11, —R10 cycloalkyl, —R10OR9 and —R10NR9R11;
- each R9 and R11 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10OH, —R10(OR10)w where w is 1-10, and —R10NR10R10;
- each R10 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl and alkynyl;
- Ay is aryl;
- Het is a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic or heteroaryl group;
- R2 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl and cycloalkyl;
- n is 0, 1 or 2;
- Y is N;
- R3 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —C(O)R7, —CO2R7, —SO2NHR9 and —NR7R8 (where R7 and R8 are not H);
- R4 is H;
- q and q′ are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of 0, 1, 2 and 3;
- each R5 and R5′ are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OAy, —OR10Ay, —OHet, —OR10Het, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(O)NR7Ay, —C(O)NHR10Het, —C(S)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7Ay, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7Ay, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —NHR10Ay, —NHR10Het, —R10 cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10C(O)R9, —R10CO2R9, —R10C(O)NR9R11, —R10C(O)NR7Ay, —R10C(O)NHR10Het, —R10C(S)NR9R11, —R10C(NH)NR9R11, —R10SO2R9, —R11SO2NR9R11, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, —R10NR7Ay, —R10NHC(NH)NR9R11, cyano, nitro and azido; or
- two adjacent R5 or R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl; and
- M1 is Li, Mg-halide or cerium-halide, wherein halide is halo.
- Generally, the process for preparing compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N; R3 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —C(O)R7, —CO2R7, —SO2NHR9 and —NR7R8 (where R7 and R8 are not H); and R4 is H (all other variables having been defined above in connection with Scheme 2), comprises the following steps:
- (a) formylating a compound of formula (IV) to prepare a compound of formula (VIII);
(b) reacting the compound of formula (VIII) with a compound of formula (IX) to prepare a compound of formula (X);
(c) oxidizing the compound of formula (X) to prepare a compound of formula (XI); and
(d) reacting the compound of formula (XI) with a compound of formula (VII) to prepare a compound of formula (I). - More specifically, compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N; R3 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —C(O)R7, —CO2R7, —SO2NHR9 and —NR7R8 (where R7 and R8 are not H); and R4 is H, may be prepared by reacting a compound of formula (XI) with a compound of formula (VII).
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 2.
- This method can be readily carried out by mixing a compound of formula (XI) with a compound of formula (VII) in a suitable solvent, optionally in the presence of a base. The reaction may be heated to 50-150° C. or performed at ambient temperature. Typical solvents include but are not limited to lower alcohols such as methanol, ethanol, isopropanol and the like. Typical bases include for example, sodium alkoxide, potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine. In another embodiment, the solvent is N,N-dimethylformamide, 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone and the like and the base is potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine.
- A compound of formula (XI) may be conveniently prepared by oxidation of a compound of formula (X).
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 2.
- Preferred oxidizing agents include but are not limited to, manganese dioxide, and the like, in an inert solvent. Suitable inert solvents include but are not limited to, dichloromethane, chloroform, N,N-dimethylformamide, ether, and the like. In another embodiment a compound of formula (X) is oxidized using oxidation methods well known to those skilled in the art of organic chemistry such as Swern oxidation (Omura, K.; Swern, D. Tetrahedron, 1978, 34, 1651) or Dess Martin periodinane oxidation (Dess, D. B.; Martin, J. C. J. Org. Chem., 1983, 48, 4155).
- A compound of formula (X) may be conveniently prepared by reacting a compound of formula (VIII) with a compound of formula (IX).
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 2.
- Preferred metals (M1) in the compounds of formula (IX) include but are not limited to, lithium, magnesium(II) halides, cerium(III) halides, and the like. A compound of formula (IX) may be purchased from commercial sources or prepared by methods known to one skilled in the art.
- A compound of formula (VIII) may be conveniently prepared from a compound of formula (IV) by a formylation procedure.
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 2.
- Typically the formulation is carried out via the Vilsmeier-Haack reaction. The Vilsmeier-Haack reagents can be purchased from commercial sources or prepared in situ. Preferable conditions include, but are not limited to treating compounds of formula (IV) with a premixed solution of phosphorous oxychloride in N,N-dimethylformamide optionally with heating the reaction to 50-150° C.
- The compounds of formula (IV) are prepared according to the process described in connection with Scheme 1 above.
- In addition to the foregoing process for preparing certain compounds of formula (I), the present invention provides certain intermediate compounds for use in the preparation of such compounds of formula (I) according to the foregoing process. Such intermediates are described in Scheme 2 above.
- Further, compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N, may be conveniently prepared by a process outlined in Scheme 3 below.
- wherein:
- p is 0, 1 or 2;
- each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OHet, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7R8, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido; or
- two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group containing 1 or 2 heteroatoms;
- each R7 and R8 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, —C(O)R9, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR9R11, —SO2R10, —SO2NR9R11, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10OR9 and —R10NR9R11;
- each R9 and R11 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10OH,
- —R10(OR10)w where w is 1-10, and —R10NR10R10;
- each R10 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl and alkynyl;
- Ay is aryl;
- Het is a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic or heteroaryl group;
- R2 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl and cycloalkyl;
- n is 0, 1 or 2;
- Y is N;
- R3 and R4 are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —C(O)R7, —CO2R7, —SO2NHR9, —NR7R8, —NHHet and —NHR10Het;
- q and q′ are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of 0, 1, 2 and 3;
- each R5 and R5′ are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OAy, —OR10Ay, —OHet, —OR10Het, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(O)NR7Ay, —C(O)NHR10 Het, —C(S)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7Ay, —S(O)rR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7Ay, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —NHR10Ay, —NHR10Het, —R10 cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10C(O)R9, —R10CO2R9, —R10C(O)NR9R11, —R10C(O)NR7Ay, —R10C(O)NHR10Het, —R10C(S)NR9R11, —R10C(NH)NR9R11, —R10SO2R9, —R10SO2NR9R11, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, —R10NR7Ay, —R10NHC(NH)NR9R11, cyano, nitro and azido; or
- two adjacent R5 or R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl; and
- M1 is Li, Mg-halide or cerium-halide, wherein halide is halo.
- Generally, the process for preparing compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N, (all formulas and all other variables having been defined above in connection with Scheme 3), comprises the following steps:
- (a) reacting a compound of formula (VIII) with a compound of formula (XII) to prepare a compound of formula (XIII);
(b) oxidizing the compound of formula (XIII) to prepare a compound of formula (XIV); and
(c) reacting the compound of formula (XIV) with a compound of formula (VII) followed by oxidation to prepare a compound of formula (I). - More specifically, compounds of formula (I) wherein Y is N, can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula (XIV) with a compound of formula (VII) followed by oxidative aromatization.
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 3.
- The condensation is conveniently carried out by treating the compound of formula (XIV) with a compound of formula (VII) in an inert solvent, optionally in the presence of a base. The reaction may be heated to 50-150° C. or performed at ambient temperature. Suitable inert solvents include lower alcohols such as, for example, methanol, ethanol, isopropanol and the like. The base is typically sodium alkoxide, potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine. In another embodiment, the solvent is N,N-dimethylformamide and the base is potassium carbonate, or an amine base such as triethylamine. The reaction produces a dihydropyrimidine intermediate.
- Preferably in the same reaction vessel, the dihydropyrimidine intermediate may be oxidized to a compound of formula (I) by the addition of an oxidizing agent. The reaction may be heated to 50-150° C. or performed at ambient temperature. Preferably, the oxidizing agent is oxygen (O2), palladium on carbon, 2,3-dichloro-5,6-dicyano-1,4-benzoquinone, or the like.
- A compound of formula (XIV) may be conveniently prepared by oxidation of a compound of formula (XIII).
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 3.
- Preferred oxidizing agents for the oxidation of compounds of formula (XIII) include but are not limited to manganese dioxide, and the like. The oxidation is typically carried out in an inert solvent such as for example, dichloromethane, chloroform, N,N-dimethylformamide, ether, and the like. In another embodiment the compound of formula (XIII) is oxidized using oxidation methods well known to those skilled in the art of organic chemistry such as Swern oxidation (Omura, K.; Swern, D. Tetrahedron, 1978, 34, 1651) or Dess Martin periodinane oxidation (Dess, D. B.; Martin, J. C. J. Org. Chem., 1983, 48, 4155).
- A compound of formula (XIII) may be conveniently prepared by reacting a compound of formula (VIII) with a compound of formula (XII).
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 3.
- A compound of formula (XII) may be purchased from commercial sources or prepared by methods known to one skilled in the art.
- The compounds of formula (VIII) may be prepared using the methods described in connection with Schemes 1 and 2 above.
- In addition to the foregoing process for preparing certain compounds of formula (I), the present invention also provides certain intermediate compounds for use in the preparation of such compounds of formula (I) according to the foregoing process. Such intermediates are described above in Scheme 3.
- A compound of formula (I), may be conveniently prepared by the process outlined in Scheme 4 below.
- wherein:
- X1 is halo, particularly bromo or iodo;
- p is 0, 1 or 2;
- each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OHet, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7R8, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R3, cyano, nitro and azido; or
- two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group containing 1 or 2 heteroatoms;
- each R7 and R8 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, —C(O)R9, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR9R11, —SO2R10, —SO2NR9R11, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10OR9 and —R10NR9R11;
- each R9 and R11 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10OH, —R10(OR10)w where w is 1-10, and —R10NR10R10;
- each R10 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl and alkynyl;
- Ay is an aryl;
- Het is a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic or heteroaryl group;
- R2 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl and cycloalkyl;
- n is 0, 1 or 2;
- Y is N or CH;
- R3 and R4 are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —C(O)R7, —CO2R7, —SO2NHR9, —NR7R8, —NHHet and —NHR10Het;
- q and q′ are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of 0, 1, 2 and 3;
- each R5 and R5′ are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OAy, —OR10Ay, —OHet, —OR10Het, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(O)NR7Ay, —C(O)NHR10Het, —C(S)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR7R3, —C(NH)NR7Ay, —S(O)rR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7Ay, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —NHR10Ay, —NHR10Het, —R10 cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10C(O)R9, —R10CO2R9, —R10C(O)NR9R11, —R10C(O)NR7Ay, —R10C(O)NHR10Het, —R10C(S)NR9R11, —R10C(NH)NR9R11, —R10SO2R9, —R10SO2NR9R11, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, —R10NR7Ay, —R10NHC(NH)NR9R11, cyano, nitro and azido; or two adjacent R5 or R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl; and
- M2 is —B(OH)2, —B(ORa)2, —B(Ra)2, —Sn(Ra)3, Zn-halide, ZnRa, or Mg-halide where Ra is alkyl or cycloalkyl and halide is halo.
- Generally, the process for preparing a compound of formula (I) (all formulas and variables having been defined above in connection with Scheme 4), comprises the following steps:
- (a) halogenating a compound of formula (IV) to prepare a compound of formula (XV); and
(b) reacting the compound of formula (XV) with a compound of formula (XVI) to prepare a compound of formula (I). - More specifically, a compound of formula (I) wherein Y is N or CH can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula (XV) with a compound of formula (XVI).
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 4.
- The reaction may be carried out in an inert solvent, in the presence of a palladium (0) or nickel (0) catalyst. The reaction may optionally be heated to about 50-150° C. Preferably the reaction is performed by reacting equimolar amounts of a compound of formula (XV) with a Het-metal compound of formula (XVI), but the reaction may also be performed in the presence of an excess of the compound of formula (XVI). The palladium or nickel catalyst is typically present in 1-10 mol % compared to the compound of formula (XV). Examples of suitable palladium catalysts include but are not limited to, tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium (0), dichlorobis(triphenyl-phosphine)palladium(II), tris(dibenzylideneacetone)dipalladium (0), and bis(diphenylphosphinoferrocene)palladium (II) dichloride. Suitable solvents include but are not limited to, N,N-dimethylformamide, toluene, tetrahydrofuran, dioxane, and 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone. When the Het-metal compound of formula (XVI) is an arylboronic acid or ester or an arylborinate the reaction is more conveniently carried out by adding a base in a proportion equivalent to, or greater than, that of the compound of formula (XVI). Het-metal compounds of formula (XVI) may be obtained from commercial sources or prepared either as discreet isolated compounds or generated in situ using methods known to one skilled in the art. (Suzuki, A. J. Organomet Chem. 1999, 576, 147; Stille, J. Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. Engl 1986, 25, 508; Snieckus, V. J. Org. Chem. 1995, 60, 292).
- A compound of formula (XV) can be prepared from a compound of formula (IV) by a halogenation procedure.
-
- wherein all variables are as defined above in connection with Scheme 4.
- Typically, the halogenation reaction is carried out by treating a compound of formula (IV) with a halogenating agent in a suitable solvent. Suitable halogenating agents include but are not limited to, iodine, N-bromosuccinimide, trialkylammonium tribromides, bromine, N-chlorosuccinimide, N-iodosuccinimide, iodine monochloride, and the like. Suitable solvents include, for example, N,N-dimethylformamide, tetrahydrofuran, dioxane, 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone, carbon tetrachloride, toluene, dichloromethane, diethyl ether, and the like.
- The compounds of formula (IV) can be prepared according to the methods described above in connection with Scheme 1.
- In addition to the foregoing process for preparing certain compounds of formula (I), the present invention also provides certain intermediate compounds for use in the preparation of such compounds of formula (I). Such intermediates are described in connection with Scheme 4 above.
- Each of the foregoing processes may further comprise the step of converting the compound of formula (I) to a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof, using techniques well known to those skilled in the art.
- As will be apparent to those skilled in the art, a compound of formula (I) may be converted to another compound of formula (I) using techniques well known in the art. For example, a compound of formula (I-A), where one R1 (i.e. denoted Hal) is halogen) may be converted to a compound of formula (I-B) using amination techniques known to those skilled in the art.
- wherein Hal is halo, particularly chloro, bromo or iodo; p′ is p-1; Amine is a group selected from the group consisting of —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, -Het bonded through N, and —NHHet, and all other variables are as defined in connection with any process above.
- The reaction can be carried out via an adaptation of procedures found in the literature (Wolfe, J. P.; Buchwald, S. L. J. Org. Chem. 2000, 65, 1144) wherein a compound of the formula (I-A) is treated with a suitable amine group, a palladium (0) or nickel (0) source and a base, optionally in a suitable solvent, at temperature ranging from ambient temperature to 200° C. Suitable sources of palladium (0) include but are not limited to palladium(II) acetate and tris(dibenzylideneacetone) dipalladium (0). Typical bases for use in the reaction include, for example sodium tert-butoxide and cesium carbonate. The reaction can be carried out in neat amine or in a suitable solvent. Toluene is an example of a suitable solvent.
- As a further example, a compound of formula (I-C) (i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R5 is O-methyl) may be converted to a compound of formula (I-D) (i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R5 is OH) using conventional demethylation techniques. Additionally, a compound of formula (I-D) may optionally be converted to a compound of formula (I-E) (i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R5 is OR10). For example, the foregoing conversions are represented schematically as follows:
- wherein q″ is q-1; Me is methyl and all other variables are as defined in connection with any process above.
- The demethylation reaction may be carried out by treating a compound of formula (I-C) in a suitable solvent with a Lewis acid at a temperature of −78° C. to room temperature, to produce a compound of formula (I-D). Typically the solvent is an inert solvent such as dichloromethane, chloroform, acetonitrile, toluene or the like. The Lewis acid may be boron tribromide, trimethylsilyl iodide or the like.
- Optionally, a compound of formula (I-D) may be further converted to a compound of formula (I-E) by an alkylation reaction. The alkylation reaction may be carried out by treating a compound of formula (I-D) in suitable solvent with an alkyl halide of formula R10-Halo where R10 is as defined above, to form another compound of formula (I-E). The reaction is typically carried out in the presence of a base and with optionally heating to 50-200° C. The reaction may be carried out in solvents such as N,N-dimethylformamide, dimethylsulfoxide and the like. Typically the base is potassium carbonate, cesium carbonate, sodium hydride or the like. Additionally, as will be apparent to those skilled in the art, the alkylation reaction can be carried out under Mitsunobu conditions.
- In yet another example, a compound of formula (I-F) (i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R5 is halo) or a compound of formula (I-H) (i.e. a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R5 is nitro) can be converted to a compound of formula (I-G) (i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R5 is NH2). Optionally, a compound of formula (I-G) may then be converted to a compound of formula (I-I) (i.e., a compound of formula (I) wherein q is 1 or more and at least one R5 is —NR7R8 where R7 and R8 are not both H). For example, the foregoing conversions are represented schematically as follows:
- wherein q″ is q-1 and all other variables are as defined in connection with any process above.
- The process of converting a compound of formula (I-F) to a compound of formula (I-G) is carried out by reacting a compound of formula (I-F) with an imine in the presence of a palladium (0) source, a base and a suitable ligand, followed by hydrolysis to give a compound of formula (I-G). See J. Wolfe, et al., Tetrahedron Letters 38:6367-6370 (1997). Typically the imine is benzophenoneimine, the palladium (0) source is tris(dibenzylideneacetone)dipalladium(0), the base is sodium tert-butoxide and the ligand is racemic-2,2′-bis(diphenylphosphino)-1,1′-binaphthyl. Suitable solvents include N,N-dimethylformamide and the like.
- A compound of formula (I-G) can also be obtained from a compound of formula (I-H) by reduction. The reduction can conveniently be carried out by using zinc, tin or iron and acid, by using tin(II)chloride, or by using palladium or platinum catalysts under hydrogen atmosphere in a suitable solvent as obvious to one skilled in the art of organic synthesis.
- Reaction of a compound of formula (I-G) with compound of formula R7-halogen in a suitable solvent in the presence of base, optionally with heating may be used to prepare a compound of formula (I-I). Typically the base is triethylamine or pyridine and the solvent is N,N-dimethylformamide and the like.
- Additional a compound of formula (I-I) can be obtained by reductive amination of a compound of formula (I-G) with ketones or aldehydes. See, A. Abdel-Magid, et al., J. Org. Chem. 61:3849-3862 (1996). Typically a compound of formula (I-G) is treated with an aldehyde or a ketone in the presence of an acid, such as acetic acid, and a reducing agent, such as sodium triacetoxyborohydride or the like, in an inert solvent such as dichloroethane or the like.
- Other transformations well known to those skilled in the art for use with anilines may be used to convert a compound of formula (I-G) to a compound of formula (I-I). It will also be apparent to one skilled in the art that the transformations described above for the transformation of a compound of formula (I) to another compound of formula (I) whereby the substituents R1 and/or R5 are altered will be equally applicable to the substitutions denoted in formula (I) by R5′.
- As will be apparent to those skilled in the art, the steps of each of the foregoing syntheses can be rearranged according to conventional knowledge in the art. Hence, the order of the steps in the foregoing syntheses is not critical to the practice of the present invention. All modifications to the synthesis exemplified here which would be obvious to those skilled in the art, are contemplated by the present invention.
- Based upon this disclosure and the following examples contained herein one skilled in the art can readily convert a compound of formula (I) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof into another compound of formula (I) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate or physiologically functional derivative thereof.
- The present invention also provides a radiolabeled compound of formula (I) and a biotinylated compound of formula (I). Radiolabeled compounds of formula (I) and biotinylated compounds of formula (I) can be prepared using conventional techniques. For example, a radiolabeled compound of formula (I) can be prepared by reacting the compound of formula (I) with tritium gas in the presence of an appropriate catalyst to produce radiolabeled compounds of formula (I).
- In one embodiment, the compounds of formula (I) are tritiated.
- The radiolabeled compounds of formula (I) and the biotinylated compounds of formula (I) are useful in assays for the identification of compounds for the treatment or prophylaxis of viral infections such as herpes viral infections. Accordingly, the present invention provides an assay method for identifying compounds which have activity for the treatment or prophylaxis of viral infections such as herpes viral infections, which method comprises the step of specifically binding the radiolabeled compound of formula (I) or the biotinylated compound of formula (I) to the target protein. More specifically, suitable assay methods will include competition binding assays. The radiolabeled compounds of formula (I) can be employed in assays according to the methods conventional in the art.
- The following examples are illustrative embodiments of the invention, not limiting the scope of the invention in any way, the invention being defined by the claims which follow. Reagents are commercially available or are prepared according to procedures in the literature. Example numbers refer to those compounds listed in the tables above. 1H and 13C NMR spectra were obtained on Varian Unity Plus NMR spectrophotometers at 300 or 400 MHz, and 75 or 100 MHz respectively. 19F NMR were recorded at 282 MHz. Mass spectra were obtained on Micromass Platform, or ZMD mass spectrometers from Micromass Ltd. Altrincham, UK, using either Atmospheric Chemical Ionization (APCI) or Electrospray Ionization (ESI). Analytical thin layer chromatography was used to verify the purity of some intermediates which could not be isolated or which were too unstable for full characterization, and to follow the progress of reactions. Unless otherwise stated, this was done using silica gel (Merck Silica Gel 60 F254). Unless otherwise stated, column chromatography for the purification of some compounds, used Merck Silica gel 60 (230-400 mesh), and the stated solvent system under pressure. All compounds were characterized as their free-base form unless otherwise stated. On occasion the corresponding hydrochloride salts were formed to generate solids where noted.
-
- 2,3-Dichloropyridine (20 g, 0.14 moles) was placed in a steel bomb. To this was added concentrated ammonium hydroxide (300 mL), the bomb sealed and heated at 190° C. for 48 hours. The vessel was cooled to room temperature and opened. Ethyl acetate and water were added. The phases were separated and the ethyl acetate phase washed with water, dried (magnesium sulfate), filtered and concentrated to a solid. This solid was crystallized from a small volume of ethyl acetate to give 12.6 g (70%) of 2-amino-3-chloropyridine as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 7.95 (dd, 1H), 7.46 (dd, 1H), 6.58 (q, 1H), 5.0 (broad s, 2H); MS m/z 129 (M+H).
- To a solution of 3-chloro-2-pyridinamine (4.8 g, 37.4 mmol) and 2-bromo-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)ethanone (8.56 g, 37.4 mmol) in ethanol (30 mL) was added potassium carbonate (5.15 g, 37.4 mmol) and the resultant solution was heated at reflux for 17 hours. The reaction mixture was cooled to room temperature and concentrated in vacuo. The resultant residue was taken up in dichloromethane, washed with water and then brine. The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane and the combined organics dried over magnesium sulfate. Filtration and concentration followed by recrystallization of the residue from ethyl acetate-hexanes resulted in 8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine (6.7 g, 70%) as a tan powder. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 8.03 (d, 1H), 7.89 (s, 1H), 7.57-7.52 (m, 2H), 7.33 (t, 1H), 7.23 (d, 1H), 6.89 (dd, 1H), 6.71 (t, 1H), 3.89 (s, 3H); 13C NMR (CDCl3): δ 159.94, 146.31, 142.96, 134.61, 129.65, 124.30, 123.58, 123.26, 118.81, 114.33, 112.02, 111.44, 109.91, 55.39; MS m/z 259 (M+1); Anal. Calcd for C14H11ClN2O: C, 64.93; H, 4.29; N, 10.83. Found: C, 64.58; H, 4.51; N, 10.52.
- N,N-Dimethylformamide (30 mL) was cooled to 0° C. and treated with phosphorous oxychloride (1.08 mL, 11.6 mmol). After the addition was complete, the mixture was warmed to room temperature and stirred for 10 minutes. To this was added 8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine (2.0 g, 7.75 mmol) and the resulting solution was stirred for 48 hours. Water was added to the reaction. The solids were then filtered and azeoptroped with methanol to give 8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine-3-carbaldehyde (2.2 g, 99%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 10.09 (s, 1H), 9.60 (d, 1H), 7.64 (d, 1H), 7.45-7.37 (m, 3H), 7.09-7.05 (m, 2H), 3.90 (s, 3H); MS m/z 287 (M+1); Anal. Calcd. for C15H11ClN2O2: C, 62.84; H, 3.87; N, 9.77. Found: C, 62.79; H, 3.92; N, 9.64.
- To a cold (−78° C.) solution of 8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine-3-carbaldehyde (1.06 g, 3.70 mmol) in tetrahydrofuran (20 mL) was added ethynyl magnesium bromide (18.53 mL, 0.5 M in tetrahydrofuran, 9.26 mmol). After 15 minutes, the resulting mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred an additional 30 minutes. Water was added and then ether. The organic layer was washed with brine. The aqueous layer was extracted with ether and the combined organics were dried over magnesium sulfate. Filtration and concentration followed by flash chromatography (1:1 hexanes-ethyl acetate to 100% ethyl acetate) provided 1-[8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-ol (910 mg, 79%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 8.61 (d, 1H), 7.33-7.26 (m, 2H), 7.16-7.11 (m, 2H), 6.88 (m, 1H), 6.79 (m, 1H), 6.14 (m, 1H), 3.85 (s, 3H), 3.27 (broad, 1H), 2.64 (d, 1H); 13C NMR (CDCl3): δ 159.64, 144.46, 134.12, 129.56, 124.99, 124.51, 123.03, 121.37, 119.43, 114.54, 114.13, 111.81, 111.27, 79.96, 75.03, 55.88, 55.38; MS m/z 313 (M+1); Anal. Calcd. for C17H13ClN2O2: C, 65.29; H, 4.19; N, 8.96. Found: C, 65.23; H, 4.34; N, 8.81.
- To a solution of 1-[8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-ol (870 mg, 2.78 mmol) in dichloromethane (150 mL) was added manganese dioxide (9.6 g, 111 mmol) and the resulting suspension was stirred at room temperature for 1.5 hours. The mixture was filtered through Celite. The filtrate was concentrated in vacuo to give 1-[8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-one (680 mg, 78%) as a golden foam. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 9.66 (d, 1H), 7.65 (d, 1H), 7.34 (t, 1H), 7.28-7.22 (m, 2H), 7.10 (t, 1H), 7.02 (m, 1H), 3.86 (s, 3H), 2.86 (s, 1H); MS m/z 311 (M+1).
- To a room temperature solution of aniline (10.0 g, 107 mmol) in ethanol (100 mL) was added cyanamide (9.6 mL, 50 wt % in water, 123 mmol) followed by the dropwise addition of concentrated nitric acid (7.56 mL). The mixture was heated at reflux for 3.5 hours and allowed to cool to room temperature. The mixture was concentrated in vacuo and the residue was crystallized from methanol/ethyl acetate/dichloromethane to yield N-phenylguanidinium nitrate (6.7 g, 32%) as a white crystalline solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): δ 9.63 (s, 1H), 7.44 (t, 2H), 7.37 (broad s, 3H), 7.29 (t, 1H), 7.23 (d, 2H); 13C NMR (DMSO-d6): δ 156.36, 135.99, 130.40, 127.19, 125.18; MS m/z 136 (M+1 of free base).
- To a solution of 1-[8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-one (58 mg, 0.19 mmol) in 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone (2 mL) was added N-phenylguanidinium nitrate (185 mg, 0.94 mmol) and potassium carbonate (129 mg, 0.94 mmol). The mixture was heated at 140° C. for 1.25 hours and then cooled to room temperature. Water was added then ether. The organic layer was washed with brine. The aqueous layer was extracted with ether and the combined organics dried over magnesium sulfate. Filtration and concentration followed by flash chromatography (2:1 hexanes-ethyl acetate) provided 4-[8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-N-phenylpyrimidin-2-amine (40 mg, 50%) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3 with 2 drops CD3OD): δ 9.45 (d, 1H), 8.16 (d, 1H), 7.60-7.58 (m, 2H), 7.39 (d, 1H), 7.34-7.29 (m, 3H), 7.17-7.15 (m, 2H), 7.07 (t, 1H), 6.95 (m, 1H), 6.75 (t, 1H), 6.58 (d, 1H), 3.79 (s, 3H); MS m/428 (M+1).
-
- To a solution of 4-[8-chloro-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-N-phenylpyrimidin-2-amine (162 mg, 0.39 mmol) in cyclopentylamine (5 mL) was added, successively, racemic-2,2′-bis(diphenylphosphino)-1,1′-binaphthyl (15.3 mg, 0.02 mmol), cesium carbonate (376 mg, 1.15 mmol) and palladium (II) acetate (3.5 mg, 0.015 mmol). The resulting mixture was heated in a sealed tube at 150° C. for 24 hours at which time the reaction was judged complete by thin layer chromatography. The solution was cooled to room temperature and ethyl acetate and water were added. The phases were separated and the organic layer was washed with water and brine. The combined organics were dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (2:1 hexanes-ethyl acetate) to give N-cyclopentyl-3-[2-(cyclopentylamino)-4-pyrimidinyl]-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-8-amine (55 mg, 31%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 8.90 (m, 1H), 8.08 (d, 1H), 7.37-7.22 (m, 2H), 6.96 (m, 1H), 6.79 (t, 1H), 6.43 (d, 1H), 6.30 (d, 1H), 5.40 (d, 1H), 5.31 (d, 1H), 4.37 (m, 1H), 3.94 (m, 1H), 3.85 (s, 3H), 2.14-2.07 (m, 4H), 1.82-1.56 (m, 12H); MS m/z 469 (M+1).
-
- In a similar manner as described in Example 1 from 2-bromo-1-(4-methylphenyl)ethanone (3.5 g, 16.4 mmol) and 3-chloro-2-pyridinamine (2.1 g, 16.4 mmol) was formed 8-chloro-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine (4 g, 99%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 8.06 (d, 1H), 7.90 (d, 2H), 7.89 (s, 1H), 7.26 (d, 2H), 7.24 (d, 1H), 6.72 (t, 1H), 2.40 (s, 3H); MS m/z 243 (M+1).
- In a similar manner as described in Example 1 from 8-chloro-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine (4 g, 16.4 mmol) and phosphorous oxychloride (2.29 mL, 24.6 mmol) in N,N-dimethylformamide (50 mL) was formed 8-chloro-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine-3-carbaldehyde (1.7 g, 38%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 10.09 (s, 1H), 9.61 (d, 1H), 7.77 (d, 2H), 7.64 (d, 1H), 7.35 (d, 2H), 7.06 (t, 1H), 2.46 (s, 3H); 13C NMR (CDCl3): δ 180.07, 158.51, 145.16, 140.34, 129.93, 129.62, 129.15, 129.01, 127.26, 123.40, 121.69, 114.81, 21.42; MS m/z 271 (M+1).
- In a similar manner as described in Example 1 from 8-chloro-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine-3-carbaldehyde (1.04 g, 3.85 mmol) and ethynyl magnesium bromide (19.25 mL, 0.5 M in tetrahydrofuran, 9.62 mmol) was formed 1-[8-chloro-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-ol (1.1 g, 99%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 8.57 (d, 1H), 7.37 (d, 2H), 7.26 (m, 1H), 7.10 (d, 2H), 6.75 (t, 1H), 6.10 (d, 1H), 3.71 (broad, 1H), 2.62 (d, 1H), 2.33 (s, 3H); MS m/z 297 (M+1).
- In a similar manner as described in Example 1 from 1-[8-chloro-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-ol (1.10 g, 3.71 mmol) was formed 1-[8-chloro-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-one (943 mg, 87%) as a brown solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 9.68 (d, 1H), 7.67-7.61 (m, 3H), 7.27-7.07 (m, 3H), 2.86 (s, 1H), 2.44 (s, 3H); MS m/z 295 (M+1).
- In a similar manner as described in Example 1 from 1-[8-chloro-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-one (200 mg, 0.68 mmol) and N-phenylguanidine nitrate (673 mg, 3.40 mmol) was formed 4-[8-chloro-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-N-phenyl-2-pyrimidinamine (117 mg, 42%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 9.46 (d, 1H), 8.22 (d, 1H), 7.63 (d, 2H), 7.56 (d, 2H), 7.41-7.34 (m, 3H), 7.25-7.22 (m, 3H), 7.10 (t, 1H), 6.77 (t, 1H), 6.66 (d, 1H), 2.41 (s, 3H); MS m/z 412 (M+1).
-
- In a similar manner as described in Example 2 from 4-[8-chloro-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-N-phenyl-2-pyrimidinamine (95 mg, 0.23 mmol) and cyclopentylamine was formed 3-(2-anilino-4-pyrimidinyl)-N-cyclopentyl-2-(4-methylphenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-8-amine (17 mg, 16%) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 8.80 (d, 1H), 8.16 (d, 1H), 7.64 (d, 2H), 7.52 (m, 2H), 7.40 (s, 1H), 7.34 (m, 2H), 7.22 (m, 2H), 7.06 (t, 1H), 6.70 (t, 1H), 6.59 (d, 1H), 6.26 (d, 1H), 5.28 (m, 1H), 3.91 (m, 1H), 2.40 (s, 3H), 2.10-2.04 (m, 2H), 1.82-1.62 (m, 6H); MS m/z 461 (M+1).
-
- In a similar manner as described in Example 1 from 2-bromo-1-(3-nitrophenyl)ethanone (4.27 g, 17.5 mmol) and 3-chloro-2-pyridinamine (2.25 g, 17.5 mmol) was formed 8-chloro-2-(3-nitrophenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine (2.80 g, 59%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3): δ 8.76 (m, 1H), 8.40 (d, 1H), 8.18 (m, 1H), 8.11 (d, 1H), 8.04 (s, 1H), 7.62 (t, 1H), 7.30 (d, 1H), 6.79 (t, 1H); 13C NMR (CDCl3): δ 148.65, 144.03, 143.35, 135.11, 132.26, 129.72, 124.51, 124.33, 123.66, 122.82, 120.97, 112.64, 110.56; MS m/z 274 (M+1); Anal. Calcd. for C13H8ClN3O2: C, 57.05; H, 2.95; N, 15.35. Found: C, 57.13; H, 3.01; N, 15.20.
- In a similar manner as described in Example 1 from 8-chloro-2-(3-nitrophenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine (2.40 g, 8.79 mmol) and phosphorous oxychloride (1.23 mL, 13.18 mmol) in N,N-dimethylformamide (25 mL) was formed 8-chloro-2-(3-nitrophenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine-3-carbaldehyde (1.7 g, 38%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): δ 10.11 (s, 1H), 9.54 (d, 1H), 8.72 (s, 1H), 8.43-8.40 (m, 2H), 7.98 (d, 1H), 7.87 (t, 1H), 7.36 (t, 1H); MS m/z 302 (M+1).
- In a similar manner as described in Example 1 from 8-chloro-2-(3-nitrophenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine-3-carbaldehyde (2.70 g, 8.97 mmol) and ethynyl magnesium bromide (54 mL, 0.5 M in tetrahydrofuran, 26.9 mmol) was formed 1-[8-chloro-2-(3-nitrophenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-ol (2.60 g, 89%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): δ 8.73 (d, 1H), 8.57 (m, 1H), 8.29 (dd, 1H), 8.19 (d, 1H), 7.83 (t, 1H), 7.64 (d, 1H), 7.11 (t, 1H), 6.64 (d, 1H), 6.09 (m, 1H), 3.67 (d, 1H); MS m/z 328 (M+1).
- In a similar manner as described in Example 1 from 1-[8-chloro-2-(3-nitrophenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-ol (2.5 g, 7.64 mmol) was formed 1-[8-chloro-2-(3-nitrophenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-one (2.20 g, 88%) as a brown solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): δ 9.54 (d, 1H), 8.57 (s, 1H), 8.39 (d, 1H), 8.18 (d, 1H), 7.98 (d, 1H), 7.77 (t, 1H), 7.37 (t, 1H), 4.46 (s, 1H); MS m/z 326 (M+1).
- In a similar manner as described in Example 1 from 4-fluoroaniline (10 g, 90 mmol) was obtained N-(4-fluorophenyl)guanidine nitrate (7.13 g, 37%) as a powder. 1H NMR (D2O): δ 7.23-7.08 (m, 4H); 19F NMR (D2O) δ-114.38; 13C NMR (D2O) δ 161.99 (d, JCF=243.5 Hz), 156.83, 130.18 (d, JCF=3.0 Hz), 128.76 (d, JCF=9.1 Hz), 116.87 (d, JCF=22.8 Hz); MS m/z 154 (M+1 of free base).
- In a similar manner as described in Example 1 from 1-[8-chloro-2-(3-nitrophenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-2-propyn-1-one (220 mg, 0.68 mmol) and N-(4-fluorophenyl)guanidine nitrate (728 mg, 3.38 mmol) was formed 4-[8-chloro-2-(3-nitrophenyl)imidazo[1,2-α]pyridin-3-yl]-N-(4-fluorophenyl)-2-pyrimidinamine (40 mg, 13%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): δ 9.92 (s, 1H), 9.29 (d, 1H), 8.54-8.48 (m, 2H), 8.32 (m, 1H), 8.14 (m, 1H), 7.80-7.72 (m, 4H), 7.17-7.11 (m, 3H), 6.80 (d, 1H); 19F NMR (DMSO-d6): δ-121.63; MS m/z 461 (M+1).
- In the following example, “MEM” means Minimal Essential Media; “FBS” means Fetal Bovine Serum; “NP40” and “Igepal” are detergents; “MOI” means Multiplicity of Infection; “NaOH” means sodium hydroxide; “MgCl2” means magnesium chloride; “dATP” means deoxyadenosine 5′ triphosphate; “dUTP” means deoxyuridine 5′ triphosphate; “dCTP” means dexoxycytidine 5′ triphosphate; “dGTP” means deoxyguanosine 5′ triphosphate; “GuSCN” means Guanidinium thiocyanate; “EDTA” means ethylenediamine tetraacetic acid; “TE” means Tris-EDTA; “SCC” means sodium chloride/sodium citrate; “APE” means a solution of ammonia acetate, ammonia phosphate, EDTA; “PBS” means phosphate buffered saline; and “HRP” means horseradish peroxidase.
- Vero 76 cells were maintained in MEM with Earle's salts, L-glutamine, 80% FBS (Hyclone, A-1111-L) and 100 units/mL Penicillin-100 μg/mL Streptomycin. For assay conditions, FBS was reduced to 2%. Cells are seeded into 96-well tissue culture plates at a density of 5×104 cells/well after being incubated for 45 min at 37° C. in the presence of HSV-1 or HSV-2 (MOI=0.001). Test compounds are added to the wells and the plates are incubated at 37° C. for 40-48 hours. Cell lysates are prepared as follows: media was removed and replaced with 150 μL/well 0.2 N NaOH with 1% Igepal CA 630 or NP-40. Plates were incubated up to 14 days at room temperature in a humidified chamber to prevent evaporation.
- For the detection probe, a gel-purified, digoxigenin-labeled, 710-bp PCR fragment of the HSV UL-15 sequence was utilized. PCR conditions included 0.5 μM primers, 180 μM dTTP, 20 μM dUTP-digoxigenin (Boehringer Mannheim 1558706), 200 μM each of dATP, dCTP, and dGTP, 1×PCR Buffer II (Perkin Elmer), 2.5 mM MgCl2, 0.025 units/μL of AmpliTaq Gold polymerase (Perkin Elmer), and 5 ng of gel-purified HSV DNA per 100 μL. Extension conditions were 10 min at 95° C., followed by 30 cycles of 95° C. for 1 min, 55° C. for 30 sec, and 72° C. for 2 min. The amplification was completed with a 10-min incubation at 72° C. Primers were selected to amplify a 728 bp probe spanning a section of the HSV1 UL15 open reading frame (nucleotides 249-977). Single-stranded transcripts were purified with Promega M13 Wizard kits. The final product was mixed 1:1 with a mixture of 6 M GuSCN, 100 mM EDTA and 200 μg/mL herring sperm DNA and stored at 4° C.
- The capture DNA plasmid (HSV UL13 region in pUC) was linearized by cutting with Xba I, denatured for 15 min at 95° C. and diluted immediately into Reacti-Bind DNA Coating Solution (Pierce, 17250, diluted 1:1 with TE buffer, pH 8) at 1 ng/μL. 75 μL/well were added to Corning (#3922 or 9690) white 96-well plates and incubated at room temperature for at least 4 hrs before washing twice with 300 μL/well 0.2×SSC/0.050% Tween-20 (SSC/T buffer). The plates were then incubated overnight at room temperature with 150 μL/well 0.2 N NaOH, 1% IGEPAL and 10 μg/mL herring sperm DNA.
- Twenty-seven (27) μL of cell lysate was combined with 45 μL of hybridization solution (final concentration: 3M GuSCN, 50 mM EDTA, 100 μg/ml salmon sperm DNA, 5×Denhardt's solution, 0.25×APE, and 5 ng of the digoxigenin-labeled detection probe). APE is 1.5 M NH4-acetate, 0.15 M ammonium phosphate monobasic, and 5 mM EDTA adjusted to pH 6.0. Mineral oil (50 μL) was added to prevent evaporation. The hybridization plates were incubated at 95° C. for 10 minutes to denature the DNA, then incubated at 42° C. overnight. The wells were washed 6× with 300 mL/well SSC/T buffer then incubated with 75 mL/well anti-digoxigenin-HRP-conjugated antibody (Boehringer Mannheim 1207733, 1:5000 in TE) for 30 min at room temperature. The wells were washed 6× with 300 μL/well with PBS/0.05% Tween-20 before 75 mL/well SuperSignal LBA substrate (Pierce) was added. The plates were incubated at room temperature for 30 minutes and chemiluminescence was measured in a Wallac Victor reader.
- The following results were obtained for HSV-1.
-
Example No. IC50 (μM) 1 1.46 2 0.35 3 3.52 4 3.54 5 2.23 - The results demonstrate that the compounds of the present invention are useful for the treatment and prophylaxis of herpes viral infections.
Claims (24)
1. A compound of formula (I):
wherein:
p is 0, 1 or 2;
each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OHet, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7R8, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido, or
two adjacent R1 groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic group containing 1 or 2 heteroatoms;
each R7 and R8 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, —C(O)R9, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR9R11, —SO2R10, —SO2NR9R11, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10OR9 and —R10NR19R11;
each R9 and R11 are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkyl, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10OH, —R10(OR10)w where w is 1-10, and —R10NR10R10;
each R10 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl and alkynyl;
Ay is aryl;
Het is a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic or heteroaryl group;
R2 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl and cycloalkyl;
n is 0, 1 or 2;
Y is CH;
R3 and R4 are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —C(O)R7, —CO2R7—SO2NHR9, —NR7R8, —NHHet and —NHR10Het;
q and q′ are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of 0, 1, 2 and 3; and
each R5 and R5′ are the same or different and are independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OAy, —OR10Ay, —OHet, —OR10Het, —C(O)R9, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —C(O)NR7Ay, —C(O)NHR10Het, —C(S)NR9R11, —C(NH)NR7R8, —C(NH)NR7Ay, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7Ay, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —NHR10Ay, —NHR10Het, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10C(O)R9, —R10CO2R9, —R10C(O)NR9R11, —R10C(O)NR7Ay, —R10C(O)NHR10Het, —R10C(S)NR9R11, —R10C(NH)NR9R11, —R10SO2R9, —R10SO2NR9R11, —R10SO2NHCOR9, —R10NR7R8, —R10NR7Ay, —R10NHC(NH)NR9R11, cyano, nitro and azido; or
two adjacent R5 or R5′ groups together with the atoms to which they are bonded form a C5-6 cycloalkyl or aryl;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
2. The compound according to claim 1 wherein p is 1 or 2.
3. The compound according to claim 1 wherein each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, cycloalkyl, Ay, Het, —OR11—C(O)R9, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —S(O)nR9, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHHet, —R10cycloalkyl, —R10Het, —R10OR9, —R10NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido.
4. The compound according to claim 1 wherein each R1 is the same or different and is independently selected form the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Het, —OR7, —S(O)nR9, —NR7R8 and —NHHet.
5. The compound according to claim 1 wherein R2 is H or alkyl.
6. The compound according to claim 1 wherein R2 is H.
7-8. (canceled)
9. The compound according to claim 1 wherein R3 and R4 are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of H, halo, alkyl, Ay, —OR7, —CO2R7 and —NR7R8.
10. The compound according to claim 1 wherein R3 and R4 are each independently H or alkyl.
11. The compound according to claim 1 wherein q and q′ are the same or different and are each independently selected from the group consisting of 0, 1 and 2.
12. The compound according to claim 1 wherein each R5 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OAy, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, —NR7Ay, —NHR10Ay, cyano, nitro and azido.
13. The compound according to claim 1 , wherein each R5 is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, —OR7, —NR7R8 and cyano.
14. The compound according to claim 1 wherein each R5′ is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, Ay, Het, —OR7, —OAy, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het, —CO2R9, —C(O)NR7R8, —S(O)2NR7R8, —NR7R8, cyano, nitro and azido.
15. The compound according to claim 1 , wherein each R5′ is the same or different and is independently selected from the group consisting of halo, alkyl, —OR7, —C(O)Ay, —C(O)Het and —NR7R8.
16. (canceled)
17. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound according to claim 1 .
18. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 17 further comprising a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent.
19. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 17 , further comprising an antiviral agent selected from the group consisting of aciclovir and valaciclovir.
20. A method for the treatment of a herpes viral infection selected from herpes simplex virus 1 and herpes simplex virus 2 in an animal, said method comprising administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of a compound according to claim 1 .
21. (canceled)
22. A method for the treatment of a condition or disease associated with a herpes viral infection selected from herpes simplex virus 1 and herpes simplex virus 2 in an animal, comprising administering to the animal a therapeutically effective amount of a compound according to claim 1 .
23-25. (canceled)
26. A process for preparing the compound according to claim 1 ,
said process comprising reacting a compound of formula (XV):
27-34. (canceled)
Priority Applications (1)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US11/381,422 US20080139594A1 (en) | 2001-10-05 | 2006-05-03 | Imidazo-Pyridine Derivatives For Use In The Treatment of Herpes Viral Infection |
Applications Claiming Priority (3)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US32770501P | 2001-10-05 | 2001-10-05 | |
US10/489,056 US7244740B2 (en) | 2001-10-05 | 2002-09-23 | Imidazo-pyridine derivatives for use in the treatment of herpes viral infection |
US11/381,422 US20080139594A1 (en) | 2001-10-05 | 2006-05-03 | Imidazo-Pyridine Derivatives For Use In The Treatment of Herpes Viral Infection |
Related Parent Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US10/489,056 Division US7244740B2 (en) | 2001-10-05 | 2002-09-23 | Imidazo-pyridine derivatives for use in the treatment of herpes viral infection |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20080139594A1 true US20080139594A1 (en) | 2008-06-12 |
Family
ID=23277681
Family Applications (2)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US10/489,056 Expired - Fee Related US7244740B2 (en) | 2001-10-05 | 2002-09-23 | Imidazo-pyridine derivatives for use in the treatment of herpes viral infection |
US11/381,422 Abandoned US20080139594A1 (en) | 2001-10-05 | 2006-05-03 | Imidazo-Pyridine Derivatives For Use In The Treatment of Herpes Viral Infection |
Family Applications Before (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US10/489,056 Expired - Fee Related US7244740B2 (en) | 2001-10-05 | 2002-09-23 | Imidazo-pyridine derivatives for use in the treatment of herpes viral infection |
Country Status (7)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (2) | US7244740B2 (en) |
EP (1) | EP1432712B1 (en) |
JP (1) | JP2005508955A (en) |
AT (1) | ATE326466T1 (en) |
DE (1) | DE60211539T2 (en) |
ES (1) | ES2262893T3 (en) |
WO (1) | WO2003031446A1 (en) |
Families Citing this family (25)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
ATE337316T1 (en) * | 2001-06-21 | 2006-09-15 | Smithkline Beecham Corp | IMIDAZO 1,2-AÖPYRIDINE DERIVATIVES FOR THE PROPHYLAXIS AND TREATMENT OF HERPES INFECTIONS |
ATE302203T1 (en) | 2002-03-07 | 2005-09-15 | Smithkline Beecham Corp | PYRAZOLOPYRIMIDINE AND PYRAZOLOTRIAZINE DERIVATIVES AND PHARMACEUTICAL PREPARATIONS CONTAINING SAME |
GB0205693D0 (en) | 2002-03-09 | 2002-04-24 | Astrazeneca Ab | Chemical compounds |
GB0205688D0 (en) | 2002-03-09 | 2002-04-24 | Astrazeneca Ab | Chemical compounds |
WO2003076434A1 (en) | 2002-03-09 | 2003-09-18 | Astrazeneca Ab | 4- imidazolyl substuited pyrimidine derivatives with cdk inhibitiory activity |
GB0205690D0 (en) | 2002-03-09 | 2002-04-24 | Astrazeneca Ab | Chemical compounds |
AU2004220648B2 (en) * | 2003-03-06 | 2010-09-16 | Boehringer Ingelheim Animal Health USA Inc. | Antiprotozoal imidazopyridine compounds |
GB0311274D0 (en) | 2003-05-16 | 2003-06-18 | Astrazeneca Ab | Chemical compounds |
GB0311276D0 (en) | 2003-05-16 | 2003-06-18 | Astrazeneca Ab | Chemical compounds |
TW200528101A (en) | 2004-02-03 | 2005-09-01 | Astrazeneca Ab | Chemical compounds |
NZ577318A (en) * | 2006-11-17 | 2012-04-27 | Nihon Mediphysics Co Ltd | Novel compounds with affinity for amyloid |
CN102702195A (en) * | 2007-10-30 | 2012-10-03 | 日本医事物理股份有限公司 | Use of novel compound having affinity for amyloid, and process for production of the same |
UA103319C2 (en) | 2008-05-06 | 2013-10-10 | Глаксосмитклайн Ллк | Thiazole- and oxazole-benzene sulfonamide compounds |
AU2009271019A1 (en) | 2008-07-14 | 2010-01-21 | Gilead Sciences, Inc. | Fused heterocyclyc inhibitors of histone deacetylase and/or cyclin-dependent kinases |
JP5640005B2 (en) | 2008-07-14 | 2014-12-10 | ギリアード サイエンシーズ, インコーポレイテッド | Imidazosylpyridine compounds as HDAC and / or CDK inhibitors |
CA2728228A1 (en) | 2008-07-14 | 2010-01-21 | Gilead Sciences, Inc. | Oxindolyl inhibitor compounds |
KR20110038159A (en) | 2008-07-28 | 2011-04-13 | 길리애드 사이언시즈, 인코포레이티드 | Cycloalkylidene and Heterocycloalkylidene Histone Deacetylase Inhibitor Compounds |
EP2440519A1 (en) | 2009-06-08 | 2012-04-18 | Gilead Sciences, Inc. | Alkanoylamino benzamide aniline hdac inihibitor compounds |
ES2463826T3 (en) | 2009-06-08 | 2014-05-29 | Gilead Sciences, Inc. | HDAC inhibitor compounds of cycloalkylcarbamate benzamide aniline |
CA2778949C (en) | 2009-10-30 | 2018-02-27 | Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv | Imidazo[1,2-b]pyridazine derivatives and their use as pde10 inhibitors |
AR080754A1 (en) | 2010-03-09 | 2012-05-09 | Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv | IMIDAZO DERIVATIVES (1,2-A) PIRAZINA AND ITS USE AS PDE10 INHIBITORS |
AU2012277912B2 (en) | 2011-06-27 | 2017-03-23 | Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv | 1-aryl-4-methyl-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]quinoxaline derivatives |
CA2872216C (en) | 2012-06-26 | 2021-07-20 | Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv | Combinations comprising pde 2 inhibitors such as 1-aryl-4-methyl-[1,2,4] triazolo [4,3-a] quinoxaline compounds and pde 10 inhibitors for use in the treatment of neurological or metabolic disorders |
MX362197B (en) | 2012-07-09 | 2019-01-08 | Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv | Inhibitors of phosphodiesterase 10 enzyme. |
EP3577116A4 (en) * | 2017-02-01 | 2020-12-02 | Aucentra Therapeutics Pty Ltd | DERIVATIVES OF N-CYCLOALKYL / HETEROCYCLOALKYL-4- (IMIDAZO [1,2-A] PYRIDINE) PYRIMIDINE-2-AMINE AS THERAPEUTICS |
Citations (17)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US4576952A (en) * | 1984-01-25 | 1986-03-18 | Beecham Group P.L.C. | Pyrazolopyridine derivatives and their use as anti-inflammatory and/or anti-allergic agents |
US4621089A (en) * | 1984-02-22 | 1986-11-04 | Beecham Group P.L.C. | Pyrazolopyridine derivatives and their use in treating inflammation and allergic conditions |
US4670432A (en) * | 1984-02-22 | 1987-06-02 | Beecham Group P.L.C. | Pyrazolopyridine derivatives useful in treating inflammation and allergic conditions |
US4719218A (en) * | 1985-12-12 | 1988-01-12 | Smithkline Beckman Corporation | Pyrrolo[1,2-a]imidazole and pyrrolo[1,2-a]pyridine derivatives and their use as 5-lipoxygenase pathway inhibitor |
US4794114A (en) * | 1986-08-19 | 1988-12-27 | Smithkline Beckman Corporation | Inhibition of interleukin-1 production by monocytes and/or macrophages |
US4985444A (en) * | 1989-01-23 | 1991-01-15 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. | Pyrazolopyridine compound and processes for preparation thereof |
US5145858A (en) * | 1985-12-12 | 1992-09-08 | Smithkline Beecham Corp. | Pyrrolo [1,2-a] imidazole and imidazo [1,2a] pyridine derivatives and their use as 5-lipoxygenase pathway inhibitors |
US5155114A (en) * | 1989-01-23 | 1992-10-13 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Company, Ltd. | Method of treatment using pyrazolopyridine compound |
US5204346A (en) * | 1990-07-18 | 1993-04-20 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. | Pyrazolopyridine compounds |
US5234930A (en) * | 1991-04-10 | 1993-08-10 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. | Pyrazolopyridine compounds which have useful pharmaceutical utility |
US5296490A (en) * | 1987-06-15 | 1994-03-22 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. | Pharmaceutically useful pyrazolopyridines |
US5300478A (en) * | 1993-01-28 | 1994-04-05 | Zeneca Limited | Substituted fused pyrazolo compounds |
US5498774A (en) * | 1989-06-23 | 1996-03-12 | Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. | Condensed heterocyclic compounds, their production and use |
US5552422A (en) * | 1995-01-11 | 1996-09-03 | Merck Frosst Canada, Inc. | Aryl substituted 5,5 fused aromatic nitrogen compounds as anti-inflammatory agents |
US5700816A (en) * | 1995-06-12 | 1997-12-23 | Isakson; Peter C. | Treatment of inflammation and inflammation-related disorders with a combination of a cyclooxygenase-2 inhibitor and a leukotriene A4 hydrolase inhibitor |
US6136839A (en) * | 1995-06-12 | 2000-10-24 | G. D. Searle & Co. | Treatment of inflammation and inflammation-related disorders with a combination of a cyclooxygenase-2 inhibitor and a 5-lipoxygenase inhibitor |
US6207675B1 (en) * | 1996-12-12 | 2001-03-27 | Rhone-Poulenc Rorer S.A. | Pyrrole derivatives, their preparation and pharmaceutical compositions containing them |
Family Cites Families (32)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US5002941A (en) | 1985-12-12 | 1991-03-26 | Smithkline Beecham Corporation | Pyrrolo(1,2-a)imidazole and imidazo(1,2-a)pyridine derivatives and their use as 5-lipoxygenase pathway inhibitors |
WO1991000092A1 (en) | 1989-06-13 | 1991-01-10 | Smithkline Beecham Corporation | Inhibition of interleukin-1 and tumor necrosis factor production by monocytes and/or macrophages |
WO1990015534A1 (en) | 1989-06-13 | 1990-12-27 | Smithkline Beecham Corporation | Monokine activity interference |
KR930700104A (en) | 1990-06-12 | 1993-03-13 | 원본미기재 | Inhibition of diseases mediated by the 5-lipoxygenase and cyclooxygenase pathways |
GB9026926D0 (en) | 1990-12-12 | 1991-01-30 | Smith Kline French Lab | Novel process |
JPH06504779A (en) | 1990-12-13 | 1994-06-02 | スミスクライン・ビーチャム・コーポレイション | New CSAIDS |
EP0563286A4 (en) | 1990-12-13 | 1995-01-11 | Smithkline Beecham Corp | Novel csaids |
ATE211384T1 (en) | 1991-01-29 | 2002-01-15 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co | USE OF ADENOSINE ANTAGONISTS TO PREVENT AND TREAT PANCREATITIS AND ULCERAS |
US5474995A (en) | 1993-06-24 | 1995-12-12 | Merck Frosst Canada, Inc. | Phenyl heterocycles as cox-2 inhibitors |
US5521213A (en) | 1994-08-29 | 1996-05-28 | Merck Frosst Canada, Inc. | Diaryl bicyclic heterocycles as inhibitors of cyclooxygenase-2 |
AU4368996A (en) | 1994-11-23 | 1996-06-17 | Neurogen Corporation | Certain 4-aminomethyl-2-substituted imidazole derivatives and 2-aminomethyl-4-substituted imidazole derivatives; new classes of dopamine receptor subtype specific ligands |
CZ313397A3 (en) | 1995-04-04 | 1998-03-18 | Glaxo Group Limited | IMIDAZO/1,2a/PYRIDINE DERIVATIVES, PROCESS OF THEIR PREPARATION AND PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION CONTAINING THEREOF |
AU5348396A (en) | 1995-05-01 | 1996-11-21 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. | Imidazo 1,2-a pyridine and imidazo 1,2-a pyridezine derivati ves and their use as bone resorption inhibitors |
WO1996041645A1 (en) | 1995-06-12 | 1996-12-27 | G.D. Searle & Co. | Combination of a cyclooxygenase-2 inhibitor and a leukotriene b4 receptor antagonist for the treatment of inflammations |
FR2757059B1 (en) | 1996-12-12 | 1999-01-29 | Rhone Poulenc Rorer Sa | NEW THERAPEUTIC APPLICATION OF PYRROLE DERIVATIVES |
EP1023066A4 (en) | 1997-06-13 | 2001-05-23 | Smithkline Beecham Corp | Novel pyrazole and pyrazoline substituted compounds |
ATE245649T1 (en) | 1997-09-05 | 2003-08-15 | Glaxo Group Ltd | 2,3-DIARYL-PYRAZOLO(1,5-B)PYRIDAZINE DERIVATIVES, THEIR PREPARATION AND THEIR USE AS CYCLOOXYGENASE 2 (COX-2) INHIBITORS |
AU3859999A (en) | 1998-05-14 | 1999-11-29 | G.D. Searle & Co. | 1,5-diaryl substituted pyrazoles as p38 kinase inhibitors |
US6245789B1 (en) | 1998-05-19 | 2001-06-12 | The Procter & Gamble Company | HIV and viral treatment |
FR2779724B1 (en) | 1998-06-10 | 2001-04-20 | Rhone Poulenc Rorer Sa | PYRROLE DERIVATIVES, THEIR PREPARATION AND THE PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS CONTAINING THEM |
WO2000026216A1 (en) | 1998-11-03 | 2000-05-11 | Glaxo Group Limited | Pyrazolopyridine derivatives as selective cox-2 inhibitors |
WO2000052008A1 (en) | 1999-02-27 | 2000-09-08 | Glaxo Group Limited | Pyrazolopyridines |
JP4032566B2 (en) | 1999-06-21 | 2008-01-16 | 東レ株式会社 | Light emitting element |
HUP0201789A3 (en) | 1999-06-28 | 2003-12-29 | Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv | Respiratory syncytial virus replication inhibitors |
GB9919778D0 (en) | 1999-08-21 | 1999-10-27 | Zeneca Ltd | Chemical compounds |
CA2311483A1 (en) | 2000-06-12 | 2001-12-12 | Gregory N Beatch | Imidazo[1,2-a]pyridine ether compounds and uses thereof |
PE20020506A1 (en) | 2000-08-22 | 2002-07-09 | Glaxo Group Ltd | PIRAZOLE DERIVATIVES FUSED AS PROTEIN KINASE INHIBITORS |
AUPQ969800A0 (en) | 2000-08-28 | 2000-09-21 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. | Pyrazolopyridine compound and pharmaceutical use thereof |
EP1341788B1 (en) | 2000-12-15 | 2005-08-10 | Glaxo Group Limited | Pyrazolopyridines |
ATE300541T1 (en) | 2000-12-15 | 2005-08-15 | Glaxo Group Ltd | PYRAZOLOPYRIDINE DERIVATIVES |
GB0103926D0 (en) | 2001-02-17 | 2001-04-04 | Astrazeneca Ab | Chemical compounds |
US7196095B2 (en) * | 2001-06-25 | 2007-03-27 | Merck & Co., Inc. | (Pyrimidinyl) (phenyl) substituted fused heteroaryl p38 inhibiting and PKG kinase inhibiting compounds |
-
2002
- 2002-09-23 JP JP2003534429A patent/JP2005508955A/en active Pending
- 2002-09-23 ES ES02800844T patent/ES2262893T3/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 2002-09-23 WO PCT/US2002/030056 patent/WO2003031446A1/en active IP Right Grant
- 2002-09-23 US US10/489,056 patent/US7244740B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 2002-09-23 EP EP02800844A patent/EP1432712B1/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 2002-09-23 DE DE60211539T patent/DE60211539T2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 2002-09-23 AT AT02800844T patent/ATE326466T1/en not_active IP Right Cessation
-
2006
- 2006-05-03 US US11/381,422 patent/US20080139594A1/en not_active Abandoned
Patent Citations (18)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US4576952A (en) * | 1984-01-25 | 1986-03-18 | Beecham Group P.L.C. | Pyrazolopyridine derivatives and their use as anti-inflammatory and/or anti-allergic agents |
US4621089A (en) * | 1984-02-22 | 1986-11-04 | Beecham Group P.L.C. | Pyrazolopyridine derivatives and their use in treating inflammation and allergic conditions |
US4670432A (en) * | 1984-02-22 | 1987-06-02 | Beecham Group P.L.C. | Pyrazolopyridine derivatives useful in treating inflammation and allergic conditions |
US4719218A (en) * | 1985-12-12 | 1988-01-12 | Smithkline Beckman Corporation | Pyrrolo[1,2-a]imidazole and pyrrolo[1,2-a]pyridine derivatives and their use as 5-lipoxygenase pathway inhibitor |
US5145858A (en) * | 1985-12-12 | 1992-09-08 | Smithkline Beecham Corp. | Pyrrolo [1,2-a] imidazole and imidazo [1,2a] pyridine derivatives and their use as 5-lipoxygenase pathway inhibitors |
US4794114A (en) * | 1986-08-19 | 1988-12-27 | Smithkline Beckman Corporation | Inhibition of interleukin-1 production by monocytes and/or macrophages |
US5296490A (en) * | 1987-06-15 | 1994-03-22 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. | Pharmaceutically useful pyrazolopyridines |
US4985444A (en) * | 1989-01-23 | 1991-01-15 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. | Pyrazolopyridine compound and processes for preparation thereof |
US5155114A (en) * | 1989-01-23 | 1992-10-13 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Company, Ltd. | Method of treatment using pyrazolopyridine compound |
US5498774A (en) * | 1989-06-23 | 1996-03-12 | Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. | Condensed heterocyclic compounds, their production and use |
US5204346A (en) * | 1990-07-18 | 1993-04-20 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. | Pyrazolopyridine compounds |
US5234930A (en) * | 1991-04-10 | 1993-08-10 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. | Pyrazolopyridine compounds which have useful pharmaceutical utility |
US5300478A (en) * | 1993-01-28 | 1994-04-05 | Zeneca Limited | Substituted fused pyrazolo compounds |
US5552422A (en) * | 1995-01-11 | 1996-09-03 | Merck Frosst Canada, Inc. | Aryl substituted 5,5 fused aromatic nitrogen compounds as anti-inflammatory agents |
US5700816A (en) * | 1995-06-12 | 1997-12-23 | Isakson; Peter C. | Treatment of inflammation and inflammation-related disorders with a combination of a cyclooxygenase-2 inhibitor and a leukotriene A4 hydrolase inhibitor |
US5990148A (en) * | 1995-06-12 | 1999-11-23 | G.D. Searle & Co. | Treatment of inflammation and inflammation-related disorders with a combination of a cyclooxygenase-2 inhibitor and a leukotriene A4 hydrolase inhibitor |
US6136839A (en) * | 1995-06-12 | 2000-10-24 | G. D. Searle & Co. | Treatment of inflammation and inflammation-related disorders with a combination of a cyclooxygenase-2 inhibitor and a 5-lipoxygenase inhibitor |
US6207675B1 (en) * | 1996-12-12 | 2001-03-27 | Rhone-Poulenc Rorer S.A. | Pyrrole derivatives, their preparation and pharmaceutical compositions containing them |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
EP1432712A1 (en) | 2004-06-30 |
US20040248917A1 (en) | 2004-12-09 |
EP1432712B1 (en) | 2006-05-17 |
DE60211539D1 (en) | 2006-06-22 |
ATE326466T1 (en) | 2006-06-15 |
ES2262893T3 (en) | 2006-12-01 |
WO2003031446A1 (en) | 2003-04-17 |
DE60211539T2 (en) | 2006-09-21 |
JP2005508955A (en) | 2005-04-07 |
US7244740B2 (en) | 2007-07-17 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US20080139594A1 (en) | Imidazo-Pyridine Derivatives For Use In The Treatment of Herpes Viral Infection | |
US6919352B2 (en) | Pyrazolopyridinyl pyridine and pyrimidine therapeutic compounds | |
US7304068B2 (en) | Substituted pyrazolo [1,5-A] pyrimidinyls and pharmaceutical uses therefore | |
US6962914B2 (en) | Pyrazolopyridinyl pyridine and pyrimidine therapeutic compounds | |
US7186714B2 (en) | Imidazo[1,2-α]pyridine derivatives for the prophylaxis and treatment of herpes viral infections | |
EP1377575B1 (en) | Antiviral pyrazolopyridine compounds | |
US7153863B2 (en) | Therapeutic compounds based on pyrazolopyridline derivatives | |
EP1423389B1 (en) | Pyrazolo-pyridines for the treatment of herpes infections | |
US20070232623A1 (en) | Pyrazolopyrimidine and Pyrazolotriazine Derivatives and Pharmaceutical Compositions Containing Them | |
US20070161653A1 (en) | Pyrazolo-Pyridine Derivatives As Antiherpes Agents | |
US7153855B2 (en) | Pyrazolopyridinyl pyrimidine therapeutic compounds |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
STCB | Information on status: application discontinuation |
Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION |